gnus-start-draft-setup: Move doc string forward.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob4325fb3d9918153de14d522286cf7a6437d718cc
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24 #include <config.h>
25 #include <signal.h>
26 #include <stdio.h>
27 #include <setjmp.h>
29 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
31 #include "lisp.h"
32 #include "blockinput.h"
34 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
35 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
36 #include "syssignal.h"
38 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
39 if this is not done before the other system files. */
40 #include "xterm.h"
41 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
43 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
44 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
45 #ifndef makedev
46 #include <sys/types.h>
47 #endif /* makedev */
49 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H
50 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
51 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_SYS_IOCTL_H) */
53 #include "systime.h"
55 #include <fcntl.h>
56 #include <ctype.h>
57 #include <errno.h>
58 #include <setjmp.h>
59 #include <sys/stat.h>
60 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
61 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
63 #include "charset.h"
64 #include "character.h"
65 #include "coding.h"
66 #include "frame.h"
67 #include "dispextern.h"
68 #include "fontset.h"
69 #include "termhooks.h"
70 #include "termopts.h"
71 #include "termchar.h"
72 #include "emacs-icon.h"
73 #include "disptab.h"
74 #include "buffer.h"
75 #include "window.h"
76 #include "keyboard.h"
77 #include "intervals.h"
78 #include "process.h"
79 #include "atimer.h"
80 #include "keymap.h"
81 #include "font.h"
82 #include "fontset.h"
83 #include "xsettings.h"
84 #include "xgselect.h"
85 #include "sysselect.h"
87 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
88 #include <X11/Shell.h>
89 #endif
91 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
92 #include <sys/time.h>
93 #endif
94 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
95 #include <unistd.h>
96 #endif
98 #ifdef USE_GTK
99 #include "gtkutil.h"
100 #endif
102 #ifdef USE_LUCID
103 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
104 #endif
106 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
107 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
108 #define HACK_EDITRES
109 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
110 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
112 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
114 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
115 #if defined USE_MOTIF
116 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
117 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
118 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
120 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
121 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
123 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
124 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
125 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
126 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
127 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
128 #ifndef XtNpickTop
129 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
130 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
131 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
132 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
134 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
137 #include "widget.h"
138 #ifndef XtNinitialState
139 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
140 #endif
141 #endif
143 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
144 #ifdef USE_XIM
145 int use_xim = 1;
146 #else
147 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
148 #endif
152 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
154 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
156 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
157 start. */
159 static int any_help_event_p;
161 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
162 static Lisp_Object last_window;
164 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
166 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
168 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
170 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
172 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
173 use. */
175 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
177 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
178 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
179 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
180 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
182 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
184 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
185 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
186 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
187 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
189 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
191 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
193 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
195 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
197 static struct {
198 struct frame *f;
199 int eventtype;
200 } pending_event_wait;
202 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
203 /* The application context for Xt use. */
204 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
205 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
206 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
208 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
210 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
212 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
213 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
215 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
217 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
218 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
219 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
221 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
223 /* Mouse movement.
225 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
226 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
227 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
228 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
230 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
232 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
233 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
234 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
235 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
236 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
237 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
238 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
239 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
240 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
241 is off. */
243 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
245 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
246 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
247 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
249 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
251 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
252 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
253 an ordinary motion.
255 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
256 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
257 event. */
259 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
261 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
262 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
263 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
264 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
265 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
266 it's somewhat accurate. */
268 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
270 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
272 static Time last_user_time;
274 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
275 events. */
277 #ifdef __STDC__
278 static int volatile input_signal_count;
279 #else
280 static int input_signal_count;
281 #endif
283 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
285 static int x_noop_count;
287 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
289 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
290 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
291 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
293 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
294 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
296 #ifdef USE_GTK
297 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
298 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
300 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
301 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
302 #endif
304 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
305 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
307 /* Used in x_flush. */
309 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources (Display *, const char *, const char *,
310 const char *);
311 extern int x_bitmap_mask (FRAME_PTR, int);
313 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
314 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
315 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
316 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
318 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
319 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
320 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
321 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
322 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
323 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
324 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
325 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
326 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
327 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
329 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
330 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
331 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
332 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
333 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
334 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
335 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
336 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
337 enum text_cursor_kinds);
339 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
340 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
341 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
342 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
343 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
344 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
345 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
346 enum scroll_bar_part *,
347 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
348 unsigned long *);
349 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
350 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
351 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
352 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
353 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
354 int *, struct input_event *);
355 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
356 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
357 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
398 #if 0
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
403 struct record
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
409 struct record event_record[100];
411 int event_record_index;
413 record_event (locus, type)
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
417 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
418 event_record_index = 0;
420 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
421 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
422 event_record_index++;
425 #endif /* 0 */
429 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
431 struct x_display_info *
432 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
434 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
436 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
437 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
438 return dpyinfo;
440 return 0;
443 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
444 #define OPACITY "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY"
446 void
447 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
449 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
450 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
451 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
452 double alpha = 1.0;
453 double alpha_min = 1.0;
454 unsigned long opac;
456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
457 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
458 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
459 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
461 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
462 alpha = f->alpha[0];
463 else
464 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
467 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
468 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
469 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471 if (alpha < 0.0)
472 return;
473 else if (alpha > 1.0)
474 alpha = 1.0;
475 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
476 alpha = alpha_min;
478 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480 /* return unless necessary */
482 unsigned char *data;
483 Atom actual;
484 int rc, format;
485 unsigned long n, left;
487 x_catch_errors (dpy);
488 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom(dpy, OPACITY, False),
489 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
490 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
491 &data);
493 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
494 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
496 XFree ((void *) data);
497 x_uncatch_errors ();
498 return;
500 else
501 XFree ((void *) data);
502 x_uncatch_errors ();
505 x_catch_errors (dpy);
506 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom (dpy, OPACITY, False),
507 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
508 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
509 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
515 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
519 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
521 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
525 /***********************************************************************
526 Starting and ending an update
527 ***********************************************************************/
529 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
530 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
531 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
532 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
533 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
535 static void
536 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
538 /* Nothing to do. */
542 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
543 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
544 position of W. */
546 static void
547 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
549 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
550 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
552 updated_window = w;
553 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
555 BLOCK_INPUT;
557 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
559 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
560 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
562 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
563 highlighting. */
564 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
565 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
572 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
574 static void
575 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
577 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
578 struct face *face;
580 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
581 if (face)
582 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
583 face->foreground);
585 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
586 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
589 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
591 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
592 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
594 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
595 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
596 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
598 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
599 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
600 here. */
602 static void
603 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
607 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
609 BLOCK_INPUT;
611 if (cursor_on_p)
612 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
613 output_cursor.vpos,
614 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
616 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
617 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
619 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
622 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
623 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
624 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
626 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
627 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
631 updated_window = NULL;
635 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
636 update_end. */
638 static void
639 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
641 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
642 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
644 #ifndef XFlush
645 BLOCK_INPUT;
646 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
647 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
648 #endif
652 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
653 complete update has been performed. The global variable
654 updated_window is not available here. */
656 static void
657 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
659 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
663 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
664 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
666 BLOCK_INPUT;
667 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
668 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
669 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
670 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
671 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
672 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
678 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
679 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
680 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
681 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
682 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
683 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
685 static void
686 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
688 struct window *w = updated_window;
689 struct frame *f;
690 int width, height;
692 xassert (w);
694 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
695 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
697 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
698 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
699 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
700 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
701 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
702 overhead is very small. */
703 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
704 && desired_row->full_width_p
705 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
706 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
707 width != 0)
708 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
709 height > 0))
711 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
713 BLOCK_INPUT;
714 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
715 0, y, width, height, False);
716 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
717 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
718 y, width, height, False);
719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
723 static void
724 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
726 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
727 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
728 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
729 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
730 struct face *face = p->face;
732 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
733 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
735 if (!p->overlay_p)
737 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
739 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
740 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
741 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
742 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
743 if (face->stipple)
744 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
745 else
746 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
748 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
749 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
750 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
751 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
752 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
753 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
754 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
755 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
757 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
759 if (sb_width > 0)
761 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
762 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
763 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
765 if (bx < 0)
767 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
768 if (left + width == p->x)
769 bx = left + sb_width;
770 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
771 bx = left;
772 if (bx >= 0)
774 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
776 nx = width - sb_width;
777 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
778 row->y));
779 ny = row->visible_height;
782 else
784 if (left + width == bx)
786 bx = left + sb_width;
787 nx += width - sb_width;
789 else if (bx + nx == left)
790 nx += width - sb_width;
794 #endif
795 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
796 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
798 if (!face->stipple)
799 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
802 if (p->which)
804 unsigned char *bits;
805 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
806 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
807 XGCValues gcv;
809 if (p->wd > 8)
810 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
811 else
812 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
814 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
815 by the server. */
816 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
817 (p->cursor_p
818 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
819 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
820 : face->foreground),
821 face->background, depth);
823 if (p->overlay_p)
825 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
826 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
827 bits, p->wd, p->h,
828 1, 0, 1);
829 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
830 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
831 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
832 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
835 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
836 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
837 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
839 if (p->overlay_p)
841 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
842 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
843 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
847 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
852 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
853 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
854 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
855 rarely happens). */
857 static void
858 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
862 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
863 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
865 static void
866 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
871 /***********************************************************************
872 Glyph display
873 ***********************************************************************/
877 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
880 int);
881 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
884 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
885 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
890 unsigned long *, double, int);
891 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
892 double, int, unsigned long);
893 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
898 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
899 int, int, int);
900 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
901 int, int, int, int, int, int,
902 XRectangle *);
903 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
906 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
907 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
908 #endif
911 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
912 face. */
914 static void
915 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
917 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
918 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
919 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && !s->cmp)
921 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
922 else
924 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
925 XGCValues xgcv;
926 unsigned long mask;
928 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
929 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
931 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
932 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
933 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
934 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
935 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
936 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
937 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
939 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
940 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
941 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
943 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
944 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
947 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
948 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
949 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
951 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
952 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
953 mask, &xgcv);
954 else
955 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
956 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
958 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
963 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
965 static void
966 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
968 int face_id;
969 struct face *face;
971 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
972 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
973 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
974 if (face == NULL)
975 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
977 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
978 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
979 else
980 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
981 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
982 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
984 if (s->font == s->face->font)
985 s->gc = s->face->gc;
986 else
988 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
989 except for FONT. */
990 XGCValues xgcv;
991 unsigned long mask;
993 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
994 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
995 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
996 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
998 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
999 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1000 mask, &xgcv);
1001 else
1002 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1003 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1005 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1008 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1012 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1013 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1014 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1016 static INLINE void
1017 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1019 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1023 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1024 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1025 pattern. */
1027 static INLINE void
1028 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1030 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1032 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1034 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1035 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1037 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1039 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1040 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1042 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1044 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1045 s->stippled_p = 0;
1047 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1049 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1053 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1055 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1058 else
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 /* GC must have been set. */
1065 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1069 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1070 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1072 static INLINE void
1073 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1075 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1076 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1078 if (n > 0)
1079 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1080 s->num_clips = n;
1084 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1085 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1086 the area of SRC. */
1088 static void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1091 XRectangle r;
1093 r.x = src->x;
1094 r.width = src->width;
1095 r.y = src->y;
1096 r.height = src->height;
1097 dst->clip[0] = r;
1098 dst->num_clips = 1;
1099 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1103 /* RIF:
1104 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1106 static void
1107 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1109 if (s->cmp == NULL
1110 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1111 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1113 struct font_metrics metrics;
1115 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1117 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1118 struct font *font = s->font;
1119 int i;
1121 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1122 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1123 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1125 else
1127 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1129 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1131 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1132 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1133 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1135 else if (s->cmp)
1137 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1138 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1143 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1145 static INLINE void
1146 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1148 XGCValues xgcv;
1149 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1150 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1151 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1152 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1156 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1157 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1158 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1159 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1160 contains the first component of a composition. */
1162 static void
1163 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1165 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1166 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1167 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1169 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1171 if (s->stippled_p)
1173 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1174 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1175 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1176 s->y + box_line_width,
1177 s->background_width,
1178 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1179 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1180 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1182 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1183 || s->font_not_found_p
1184 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1185 || force_p)
1187 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1188 s->background_width,
1189 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1190 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1196 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1198 static void
1199 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1201 int i, x;
1203 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1204 of S to the right of that box line. */
1205 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1206 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1207 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1208 else
1209 x = s->x;
1211 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1212 loaded. */
1213 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1215 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1217 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1218 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1219 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1220 s->height - 1);
1221 x += g->pixel_width;
1224 else
1226 struct font *font = s->font;
1227 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1228 int y;
1230 if (font->vertical_centering)
1231 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1233 y = s->ybase - boff;
1234 if (s->for_overlaps
1235 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1236 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1237 else
1238 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1239 if (s->face->overstrike)
1240 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1244 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1246 static void
1247 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1249 int i, j, x;
1250 struct font *font = s->font;
1252 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1253 of S to the right of that box line. */
1254 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1255 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1256 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1257 else
1258 x = s->x;
1260 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1261 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1262 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1263 this composition. */
1265 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1266 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1267 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1271 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1273 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1275 int y = s->ybase;
1277 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1278 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1280 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1281 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1283 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1284 if (s->face->overstrike)
1285 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1288 else
1290 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1291 Lisp_Object glyph;
1292 int y = s->ybase;
1293 int width = 0;
1295 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1297 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1298 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1299 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1300 else
1302 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1304 if (j < i)
1306 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1308 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1309 x += width;
1311 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1312 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1313 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1314 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1315 if (s->face->overstrike)
1316 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1317 x += wadjust;
1318 j = i + 1;
1319 width = 0;
1322 if (j < i)
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1325 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1332 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1334 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1335 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1336 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1337 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1338 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1341 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1342 cannot be determined. */
1344 static struct frame *
1345 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1347 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1348 Lisp_Object tail;
1349 struct frame *f;
1351 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1353 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1354 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1355 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1356 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1357 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1358 widget = XtParent (widget);
1360 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1361 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1362 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1363 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1364 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1365 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1366 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1367 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1368 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1369 return f;
1371 abort ();
1375 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1376 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1377 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1378 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1381 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1383 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1384 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1388 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1389 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1390 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1391 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1392 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1393 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1396 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1397 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1399 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1400 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1404 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1405 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1407 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1409 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1410 sizeof (Screen *)},
1411 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1412 sizeof (Colormap)}
1416 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1417 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1419 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1422 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1424 DPY is the display we are working on.
1426 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1427 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1428 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1429 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1431 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1432 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1434 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1435 we allocated the color or not.
1437 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1439 static Boolean
1440 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1441 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1442 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1444 Screen *screen;
1445 Colormap cmap;
1446 Pixel pixel;
1447 String color_name;
1448 XColor color;
1450 if (*nargs != 2)
1452 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1453 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1454 "XtToolkitError",
1455 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1456 return False;
1459 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1460 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1461 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1463 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1465 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1466 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1468 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1470 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1471 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1473 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1474 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1476 pixel = color.pixel;
1477 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1479 else
1481 String params[1];
1482 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1484 params[0] = color_name;
1485 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1486 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1487 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1488 params, &nparams);
1489 return False;
1492 if (to->addr != NULL)
1494 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1496 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1497 return False;
1500 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1502 else
1504 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1505 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1508 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1509 return True;
1513 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1514 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1515 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1517 APP is the application context in which we work.
1519 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1520 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1521 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1523 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1525 static void
1526 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1527 Cardinal *nargs)
1529 if (*nargs != 2)
1531 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1532 "XtToolkitError",
1533 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1534 NULL, NULL);
1536 else if (closure != NULL)
1538 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1539 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1540 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1541 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1542 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1547 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1550 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1551 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1552 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1553 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1555 static const XColor *
1556 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1558 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1560 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1562 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1563 int i;
1565 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1566 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1567 dpyinfo->color_cells
1568 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1569 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1571 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1572 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1574 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1575 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1578 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1579 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1583 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1584 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1586 void
1587 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1589 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1591 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1593 int i;
1594 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1596 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1597 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1598 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1599 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1602 else
1603 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1607 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1608 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1610 void
1611 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1613 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1617 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1618 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1619 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1620 allocated. */
1622 static int
1623 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1625 int rc;
1627 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1628 if (rc == 0)
1630 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1631 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1632 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1633 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1634 int nearest, i;
1635 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1636 int ncells;
1637 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1639 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1641 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1642 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1643 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1644 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1646 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1648 nearest = i;
1649 nearest_delta = delta;
1653 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1654 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1655 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1656 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1658 else
1660 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1661 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1662 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1664 XColor *cached_color;
1666 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1667 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1668 (cached_color->red != color->red
1669 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1670 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1672 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1673 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1674 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1678 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1679 if (rc)
1680 register_color (color->pixel);
1681 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1683 return rc;
1687 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1688 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1689 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1690 allocated. */
1693 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1695 gamma_correct (f, color);
1696 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1700 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1701 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1702 get color reference counts right. */
1704 unsigned long
1705 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1707 XColor color;
1709 color.pixel = pixel;
1710 BLOCK_INPUT;
1711 x_query_color (f, &color);
1712 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1714 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1715 register_color (pixel);
1716 #endif
1717 return color.pixel;
1721 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1722 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1723 get color reference counts right. */
1725 unsigned long
1726 x_copy_dpy_color (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int pixel)
1728 XColor color;
1730 color.pixel = pixel;
1731 BLOCK_INPUT;
1732 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1733 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1734 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1735 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1736 register_color (pixel);
1737 #endif
1738 return color.pixel;
1742 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1743 boosted.
1745 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1746 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1747 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1748 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1749 use an additional additive factor.
1751 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1752 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1753 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1756 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1757 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1758 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1759 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1760 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1763 static int
1764 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1766 XColor color, new;
1767 long bright;
1768 int success_p;
1770 /* Get RGB color values. */
1771 color.pixel = *pixel;
1772 x_query_color (f, &color);
1774 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1775 xassert (factor >= 0);
1776 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1777 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1778 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1780 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1781 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1783 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1784 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1785 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1786 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1787 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1789 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1790 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1791 /* The additive adjustment. */
1792 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1794 if (factor < 1)
1796 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1797 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1798 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1800 else
1802 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1803 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1804 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1808 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1809 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1810 if (success_p)
1812 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1814 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1815 delta to the RGB values. */
1816 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1818 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1819 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1820 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1821 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1823 else
1824 success_p = 1;
1825 *pixel = new.pixel;
1828 return success_p;
1832 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1833 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1834 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1835 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1836 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1837 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1839 static void
1840 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1842 XGCValues xgcv;
1843 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1844 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1845 unsigned long pixel;
1846 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1847 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1848 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1849 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1851 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1852 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1854 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1855 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1856 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1857 if (relief->gc
1858 && relief->allocated_p)
1860 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1861 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1864 /* Allocate new color. */
1865 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1866 pixel = background;
1867 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1868 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1870 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1871 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1874 if (relief->gc == 0)
1876 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1877 mask |= GCStipple;
1878 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1880 else
1881 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1885 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1887 static void
1888 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1890 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1891 unsigned long color;
1893 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1894 color = s->face->box_color;
1895 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1896 && s->img->pixmap
1897 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1898 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1899 else
1901 XGCValues xgcv;
1903 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1904 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1905 color = xgcv.background;
1908 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1909 || color != di->relief_background)
1911 di->relief_background = color;
1912 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1913 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1914 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1915 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1920 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1921 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1922 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1923 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1924 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1925 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1926 when drawing. */
1928 static void
1929 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1930 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1931 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1932 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1934 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1935 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1936 int i;
1937 GC gc;
1939 if (raised_p)
1940 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1941 else
1942 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1943 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1945 /* Top. */
1946 if (top_p)
1947 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1948 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1949 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
1950 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
1952 /* Left. */
1953 if (left_p)
1954 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1955 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1956 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
1958 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1959 if (raised_p)
1960 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1961 else
1962 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1963 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1965 /* Bottom. */
1966 if (bot_p)
1967 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1968 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1969 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
1970 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
1972 /* Right. */
1973 if (right_p)
1974 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
1975 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1976 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
1978 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
1982 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
1983 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
1984 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
1985 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
1986 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
1987 rectangle to use when drawing. */
1989 static void
1990 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
1991 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1992 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
1994 XGCValues xgcv;
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
1997 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
1998 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2000 /* Top. */
2001 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2002 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2004 /* Left. */
2005 if (left_p)
2006 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2007 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2009 /* Bottom. */
2010 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2011 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2013 /* Right. */
2014 if (right_p)
2015 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2016 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2018 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2019 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2023 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2025 static void
2026 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2028 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2029 int left_p, right_p;
2030 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2031 XRectangle clip_rect;
2033 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2034 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2035 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2037 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2038 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2039 ? s->first_glyph
2040 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2042 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2043 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2044 left_x = s->x;
2045 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2046 ? last_x - 1
2047 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2048 top_y = s->y;
2049 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2051 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2052 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2053 && (s->prev == NULL
2054 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2055 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2056 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2057 && (s->next == NULL
2058 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2060 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2062 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2063 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2064 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2065 else
2067 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2068 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2069 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2074 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2076 static void
2077 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2079 int x = s->x;
2080 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2082 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2083 right of that line. */
2084 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2085 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2086 && s->slice.x == 0)
2087 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2089 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2090 by that margin. */
2091 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2092 x += s->img->hmargin;
2093 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2094 y += s->img->vmargin;
2096 if (s->img->pixmap)
2098 if (s->img->mask)
2100 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2101 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2102 trust on the shape extension to be available
2103 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2104 manually. */
2105 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2106 | GCFunction);
2107 XGCValues xgcv;
2108 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2110 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2111 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2112 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2113 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2114 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2116 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2117 image_rect.x = x;
2118 image_rect.y = y;
2119 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2120 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2121 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2122 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2123 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2124 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2126 else
2128 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2130 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2131 image_rect.x = x;
2132 image_rect.y = y;
2133 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2134 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2135 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2136 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2137 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2138 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2140 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2141 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2142 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2143 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2144 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2145 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2146 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2148 int r = s->img->relief;
2149 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2150 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2151 x - r, y - r,
2152 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2153 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2157 else
2158 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2159 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2160 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2164 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2166 static void
2167 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2169 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2170 XRectangle r;
2171 int x = s->x;
2172 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2174 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2175 right of that line. */
2176 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2177 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2178 && s->slice.x == 0)
2179 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2181 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2182 by that margin. */
2183 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += s->img->hmargin;
2185 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2186 y += s->img->vmargin;
2188 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2189 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2191 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2192 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2194 else
2196 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2197 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2200 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2201 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2203 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2204 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2205 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2206 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2208 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2209 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2210 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2211 s->slice.y == 0,
2212 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2213 s->slice.x == 0,
2214 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2215 &r);
2219 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2221 static void
2222 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2224 int x = 0;
2225 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2227 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2228 right of that line. */
2229 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2230 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2231 && s->slice.x == 0)
2232 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2234 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2235 by that margin. */
2236 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2237 x += s->img->hmargin;
2238 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2239 y += s->img->vmargin;
2241 if (s->img->pixmap)
2243 if (s->img->mask)
2245 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2246 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2247 trust on the shape extension to be available
2248 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2249 manually. */
2250 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2251 | GCFunction);
2252 XGCValues xgcv;
2254 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2255 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2256 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2257 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2258 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2260 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2261 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2262 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2263 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2265 else
2267 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2268 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2269 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2271 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2272 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2273 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2274 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2275 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2276 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2277 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2279 int r = s->img->relief;
2280 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2281 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2282 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2283 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2287 else
2288 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2289 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2290 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2294 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2295 give the rectangle to draw. */
2297 static void
2298 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2300 if (s->stippled_p)
2302 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2303 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2304 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2305 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2307 else
2308 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2312 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2314 s->y
2315 s->x +-------------------------
2316 | s->face->box
2318 | +-------------------------
2319 | | s->img->margin
2321 | | +-------------------
2322 | | | the image
2326 static void
2327 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2329 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2330 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2331 int height;
2332 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2334 height = s->height;
2335 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2336 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2337 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2338 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2340 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2341 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2342 flickering. */
2343 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2344 if (height > s->slice.height
2345 || s->img->hmargin
2346 || s->img->vmargin
2347 || s->img->mask
2348 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2349 || s->width != s->background_width)
2351 if (s->img->mask)
2353 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2354 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2355 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2356 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2357 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2359 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2360 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2361 s->background_width,
2362 s->height, depth);
2364 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2365 pixmap. */
2366 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2369 if (s->stippled_p)
2371 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2372 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2373 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2374 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2375 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2376 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2377 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2379 else
2381 XGCValues xgcv;
2382 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2383 &xgcv);
2384 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2385 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2386 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2387 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2390 else
2392 int x = s->x;
2393 int y = s->y;
2395 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2396 && s->slice.x == 0)
2397 x += box_line_hwidth;
2399 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2400 y += box_line_vwidth;
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2405 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2408 /* Draw the foreground. */
2409 if (pixmap != None)
2411 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2412 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2413 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2414 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2415 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2417 else
2418 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2420 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2421 if (s->img->relief
2422 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2423 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2424 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2428 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2430 static void
2431 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2433 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2435 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2436 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2438 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2439 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2440 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2441 int x = s->x;
2443 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2445 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2447 if (x < left_x)
2449 background_width -= left_x - x;
2450 x = left_x;
2453 else
2455 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2456 stretch glyph. */
2457 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2459 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2460 background_width -= x - right_x;
2461 x += background_width;
2463 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2464 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2465 x -= width;
2467 /* Draw cursor. */
2468 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2470 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2471 if (width < background_width)
2473 int y = s->y;
2474 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2475 XRectangle r;
2476 GC gc;
2478 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2479 x += width;
2480 else
2481 x = s->x;
2482 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2483 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2485 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2486 gc = s->gc;
2488 else
2489 gc = s->face->gc;
2491 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2492 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2494 if (s->face->stipple)
2496 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2497 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2498 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2499 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2501 else
2503 XGCValues xgcv;
2504 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2505 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2506 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2507 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2511 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2513 int background_width = s->background_width;
2514 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2516 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2517 except for header line and mode line. */
2518 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2520 background_width -= left_x - x;
2521 x = left_x;
2523 if (background_width > 0)
2524 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2527 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2531 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2533 static void
2534 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2536 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2538 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2539 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2540 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2541 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2543 int width;
2544 struct glyph_string *next;
2546 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2547 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2548 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2549 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2551 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2552 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2553 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2554 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2555 else
2556 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2557 next->num_clips = 0;
2561 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2562 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2564 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2565 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2566 if (!s->for_overlaps
2567 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2568 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2569 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2572 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2573 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2574 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2575 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2576 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2578 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2579 && !s->clip_tail
2580 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2581 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2582 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2583 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2584 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2585 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2586 else
2587 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2589 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2591 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2592 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2593 break;
2595 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2596 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2597 break;
2599 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2600 if (s->for_overlaps)
2601 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2602 else
2603 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2604 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2605 break;
2607 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2608 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2609 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2610 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2611 else
2612 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2613 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2614 break;
2616 default:
2617 abort ();
2620 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2622 /* Draw underline. */
2623 if (s->face->underline_p)
2625 unsigned long thickness, position;
2626 int y;
2628 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2630 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2631 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2632 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2634 else
2636 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2637 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2638 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2639 else
2640 thickness = 1;
2641 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2642 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2643 else
2645 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2646 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2647 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2648 specs, and its default is
2650 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2651 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2653 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2654 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2655 position = s->font->underline_position;
2656 else if (s->font)
2657 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2658 else
2659 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2661 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2663 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2664 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2665 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2666 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2667 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2668 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2669 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2670 s->underline_position = position;
2671 y = s->ybase + position;
2672 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2673 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2674 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2675 else
2677 XGCValues xgcv;
2678 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2679 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2680 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2681 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2682 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2686 /* Draw overline. */
2687 if (s->face->overline_p)
2689 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2691 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2692 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2693 s->width, h);
2694 else
2696 XGCValues xgcv;
2697 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2698 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2699 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2700 s->width, h);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2705 /* Draw strike-through. */
2706 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2708 unsigned long h = 1;
2709 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2711 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2712 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2713 s->width, h);
2714 else
2716 XGCValues xgcv;
2717 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2718 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2719 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2720 s->width, h);
2721 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2725 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2726 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2727 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2729 if (s->prev)
2731 struct glyph_string *prev;
2733 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2734 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2735 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2737 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2738 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2739 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2741 prev->hl = s->hl;
2742 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2743 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2744 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2745 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2746 else
2747 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2748 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2749 prev->hl = save;
2750 prev->num_clips = 0;
2754 if (s->next)
2756 struct glyph_string *next;
2758 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2759 if (next->hl != s->hl
2760 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2762 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2763 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2764 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2766 next->hl = s->hl;
2767 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2768 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2769 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2770 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2771 else
2772 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2773 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2774 next->hl = save;
2775 next->num_clips = 0;
2780 /* Reset clipping. */
2781 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2782 s->num_clips = 0;
2785 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2787 void
2788 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2790 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2791 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2792 x, y, width, height,
2793 x + shift_by, y);
2796 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2797 for X frames. */
2799 static void
2800 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2802 abort ();
2806 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2807 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2809 void
2810 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2812 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2813 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2817 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2819 static void
2820 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2822 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2823 longer visible. */
2824 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2825 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2826 output_cursor.x = -1;
2828 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2829 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2830 BLOCK_INPUT;
2831 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2833 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2834 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2835 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2837 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2838 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2839 redisplay, do it here. */
2840 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2841 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2842 #endif
2844 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2846 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2851 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2853 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2854 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2856 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2859 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2860 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2862 static int
2863 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2865 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2866 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2867 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2869 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2870 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2871 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2874 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2876 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2877 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2878 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2881 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2882 positive. */
2883 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2884 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2886 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2887 negative. */
2888 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2891 void
2892 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2894 BLOCK_INPUT;
2897 #ifdef USE_GTK
2898 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2899 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
2900 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2901 GdkGCValues vals;
2902 GdkGC *gc;
2903 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2904 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2905 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
2906 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
2907 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
2908 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
2909 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
2910 #else
2911 GC gc;
2913 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2914 pixels into background pixels. */
2916 XGCValues values;
2918 values.function = GXxor;
2919 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
2920 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
2922 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2923 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2925 #endif
2927 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2928 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2929 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2930 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2931 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2932 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2933 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2935 int width;
2937 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2938 edge it is next to. */
2939 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2941 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2942 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2943 break;
2945 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2946 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2947 break;
2949 default:
2950 break;
2953 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2955 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2956 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2958 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2959 flash_left,
2960 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2961 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
2962 width, flash_height);
2963 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2964 flash_left,
2965 (height - flash_height
2966 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2967 width, flash_height);
2970 else
2971 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2972 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2973 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2974 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2976 x_flush (f);
2979 struct timeval wakeup;
2981 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2983 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2984 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2985 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2986 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2988 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2989 available. */
2990 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2992 struct timeval current;
2993 struct timeval timeout;
2995 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2997 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2998 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2999 break;
3001 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3002 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3003 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3005 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3006 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3010 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3011 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3013 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3014 flash_left,
3015 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3016 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3017 width, flash_height);
3018 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3019 flash_left,
3020 (height - flash_height
3021 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3022 width, flash_height);
3024 else
3025 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3026 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3027 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3028 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3030 #ifdef USE_GTK
3031 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3032 #undef XFillRectangle
3033 #else
3034 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3035 #endif
3036 x_flush (f);
3040 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3043 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3046 static void
3047 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3049 BLOCK_INPUT;
3050 if (invisible)
3052 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3053 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3054 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3056 else
3057 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3058 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3059 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3064 /* Make audible bell. */
3066 void
3067 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3069 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3071 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3072 if (visible_bell)
3073 XTflash (f);
3074 else
3075 #endif
3077 BLOCK_INPUT;
3078 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3079 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3080 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3086 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3087 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3088 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3089 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3091 static void
3092 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3094 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3099 /***********************************************************************
3100 Line Dance
3101 ***********************************************************************/
3103 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3104 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3106 static void
3107 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3109 abort ();
3113 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3115 static void
3116 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3118 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3119 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3121 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3122 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3123 fringe of W. */
3124 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3126 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3127 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3128 bottom_y = y + height;
3130 if (to_y < from_y)
3132 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3133 line at the bottom. */
3134 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3135 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3136 else
3137 height = run->height;
3139 else
3141 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3142 at the bottom. */
3143 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3144 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3145 else
3146 height = run->height;
3149 BLOCK_INPUT;
3151 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3152 updated_window = w;
3153 x_clear_cursor (w);
3155 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3156 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3157 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3158 x, from_y,
3159 width, height,
3160 x, to_y);
3162 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3167 /***********************************************************************
3168 Exposure Events
3169 ***********************************************************************/
3172 static void
3173 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3175 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3176 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3177 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3178 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3179 BLOCK_INPUT;
3180 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3181 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3183 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3184 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3187 static void
3188 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3190 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3191 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3192 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3193 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3194 BLOCK_INPUT;
3195 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3196 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3197 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3198 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3199 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3202 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3203 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3204 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3205 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3206 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3208 static void
3209 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3211 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3213 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3215 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3216 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3217 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3219 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3220 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3222 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3223 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3224 else
3225 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3228 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3231 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3232 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3233 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3235 static void
3236 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3238 if (type == FocusIn)
3240 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3242 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3243 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3245 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3246 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3247 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3248 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3249 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3251 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3252 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3256 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3258 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3259 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3260 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3261 #endif
3263 else if (type == FocusOut)
3265 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3267 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3269 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3270 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3273 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3274 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3275 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3276 #endif
3277 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3278 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3282 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3283 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3285 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3287 static void
3288 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3290 struct frame *frame;
3292 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3293 if (! frame)
3294 return;
3296 switch (event->type)
3298 case EnterNotify:
3299 case LeaveNotify:
3301 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3302 int focus_state
3303 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3305 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3306 && event->xcrossing.focus
3307 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3308 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3309 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3310 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3312 break;
3314 case FocusIn:
3315 case FocusOut:
3316 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3317 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3318 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3319 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3320 break;
3322 case ClientMessage:
3323 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3325 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3326 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3327 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3329 break;
3334 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3336 void
3337 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3339 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3342 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3343 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3344 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3346 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3347 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3348 the appropriate X display info. */
3350 static void
3351 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3353 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3356 static void
3357 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3359 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3361 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3363 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3364 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3365 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3366 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3367 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3369 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3370 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3373 else
3374 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3376 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3378 if (old_highlight)
3379 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3380 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3381 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3387 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3389 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3390 static void
3391 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3393 int min_code, max_code;
3394 KeySym *syms;
3395 int syms_per_code;
3396 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3398 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3399 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3400 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3401 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3402 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3404 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3406 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3407 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3408 &syms_per_code);
3409 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3411 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3412 Alt keysyms are on. */
3414 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3415 int found_alt_or_meta;
3417 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3419 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3420 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3422 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3424 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3425 if (code == 0)
3426 continue;
3428 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3430 int code_col;
3432 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3434 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3436 switch (sym)
3438 case XK_Meta_L:
3439 case XK_Meta_R:
3440 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3441 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3442 break;
3444 case XK_Alt_L:
3445 case XK_Alt_R:
3446 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3447 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3448 break;
3450 case XK_Hyper_L:
3451 case XK_Hyper_R:
3452 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3453 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3454 code_col = syms_per_code;
3455 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3456 break;
3458 case XK_Super_L:
3459 case XK_Super_R:
3460 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3461 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3462 code_col = syms_per_code;
3463 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3464 break;
3466 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3467 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3468 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3469 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3470 code_col = syms_per_code;
3471 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3472 break;
3480 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3481 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3483 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3484 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3487 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3488 make them just meta, not alt. */
3489 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3491 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3494 XFree ((char *) syms);
3495 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3498 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3499 Emacs uses. */
3501 unsigned int
3502 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3505 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3506 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3507 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3508 Lisp_Object tem;
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3516 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3517 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3520 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3521 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3522 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3523 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3524 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3525 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3528 static unsigned int
3529 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3531 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3532 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3533 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3534 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3536 Lisp_Object tem;
3538 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3539 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3540 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3541 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3542 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3543 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3544 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3545 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3548 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3549 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3550 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3551 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3552 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3553 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3556 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3558 char *
3559 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3561 char *value;
3563 BLOCK_INPUT;
3564 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3565 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3567 return value;
3572 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3574 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3576 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3577 the mouse. */
3579 static Lisp_Object
3580 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3582 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3583 otherwise. */
3584 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3585 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3586 result->timestamp = event->time;
3587 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3588 event->state)
3589 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3590 ? up_modifier
3591 : down_modifier));
3593 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3594 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3595 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3596 result->arg = Qnil;
3597 return Qnil;
3601 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3602 The input handler calls this.
3604 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3605 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3606 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3607 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3609 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3610 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3612 static int
3613 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3615 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3616 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3617 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3619 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3620 return 0;
3622 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3624 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3625 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3626 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3627 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3628 return 1;
3632 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3633 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3634 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3635 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3636 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3637 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3639 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3640 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3641 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3642 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3643 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3644 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3645 return 1;
3648 return 0;
3652 /************************************************************************
3653 Mouse Face
3654 ************************************************************************/
3656 static void
3657 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3659 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3660 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3661 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3662 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3663 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3668 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3669 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3671 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3672 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3673 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3674 position on the scroll bar.
3676 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3677 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3678 the mouse is over.
3680 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3681 was at this position.
3683 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3685 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3686 movement. */
3688 static void
3689 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
3691 FRAME_PTR f1;
3693 BLOCK_INPUT;
3695 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3696 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3697 else
3699 Window root;
3700 int root_x, root_y;
3702 Window dummy_window;
3703 int dummy;
3705 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3707 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3708 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3709 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3710 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3711 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3713 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3715 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3716 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3717 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3719 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3720 &root,
3722 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3723 a different screen. */
3724 &dummy_window,
3726 /* The position on that root window. */
3727 &root_x, &root_y,
3729 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3730 &dummy, &dummy,
3732 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3733 we don't care. */
3734 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3736 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3737 containing the pointer. */
3739 Window win, child;
3740 int win_x, win_y;
3741 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3743 win = root;
3745 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3746 structure is changing at the same time this function
3747 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3749 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3751 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3752 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3754 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3755 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3756 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3758 /* From-window, to-window. */
3759 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3761 /* From-position, to-position. */
3762 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3764 /* Child of win. */
3765 &child);
3766 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3768 else
3770 while (1)
3772 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3774 /* From-window, to-window. */
3775 root, win,
3777 /* From-position, to-position. */
3778 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3780 /* Child of win. */
3781 &child);
3783 if (child == None || child == win)
3784 break;
3785 #ifdef USE_GTK
3786 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3787 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3788 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3789 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3790 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3791 break;
3792 #endif
3793 win = child;
3794 parent_x = win_x;
3795 parent_y = win_y;
3798 /* Now we know that:
3799 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3800 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3801 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3802 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3803 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3804 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3805 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3806 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3807 never use them in that case.) */
3809 #ifdef USE_GTK
3810 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3811 want the edit window. */
3812 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3813 #else
3814 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3815 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3816 #endif
3818 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3819 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3820 on the frame. */
3821 if (f1 != NULL
3822 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3823 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3824 f1 = NULL;
3825 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3828 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3829 f1 = 0;
3831 x_uncatch_errors ();
3833 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3834 if (! f1)
3836 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3838 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3840 if (bar)
3842 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3843 win_x = parent_x;
3844 win_y = parent_y;
3848 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3849 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3851 if (f1)
3853 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3854 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3855 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3856 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3857 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3858 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3859 the frame are divided into. */
3861 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3862 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3864 *bar_window = Qnil;
3865 *part = 0;
3866 *fp = f1;
3867 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3868 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3869 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3874 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3879 /***********************************************************************
3880 Scroll bars
3881 ***********************************************************************/
3883 /* Scroll bar support. */
3885 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3886 manages it.
3887 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3888 bits. */
3890 static struct scroll_bar *
3891 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
3893 Lisp_Object tail;
3895 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3896 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3897 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3899 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3901 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3903 frame = XCAR (tail);
3904 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3905 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
3906 abort ();
3908 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
3909 continue;
3911 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3912 right window ID. */
3913 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3914 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3915 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3916 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3917 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3918 condemned = Qnil,
3919 ! NILP (bar));
3920 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3921 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
3922 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3923 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3926 return 0;
3930 #if defined USE_LUCID
3932 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3933 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3935 static Widget
3936 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
3938 Lisp_Object tail;
3940 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
3942 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
3944 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3945 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3947 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3948 return menu_bar;
3952 return NULL;
3955 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3958 /************************************************************************
3959 Toolkit scroll bars
3960 ************************************************************************/
3962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3964 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
3965 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
3966 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
3967 struct scroll_bar *);
3968 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
3969 int, int, int);
3972 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3973 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3975 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3977 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3979 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3981 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3982 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3984 #ifndef USE_GTK
3985 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3987 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3989 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3991 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3992 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3993 to avoid jerkyness. */
3995 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3997 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3998 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3999 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4000 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4002 static void
4003 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4004 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4006 int scroll_bar_p;
4007 char *end_action;
4009 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4010 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4011 end_action = "Release";
4012 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4013 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4014 end_action = "EndScroll";
4015 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4017 if (scroll_bar_p
4018 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4019 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4021 struct window *w;
4023 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4024 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4025 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4027 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4029 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4030 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4031 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4033 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4034 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4036 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4037 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4040 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4042 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4043 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4045 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4046 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4049 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4050 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4051 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4052 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4054 static void
4055 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4057 XEvent event;
4058 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4059 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4060 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4061 int i;
4063 BLOCK_INPUT;
4065 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4066 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4067 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4068 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4069 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4070 ev->format = 32;
4072 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4073 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4074 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4075 into that array in the event. */
4076 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4077 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4078 break;
4080 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4082 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4083 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4084 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4086 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4087 nbytes);
4088 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4089 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4092 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4093 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4094 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4095 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4096 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4097 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4099 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4100 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4102 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4103 #endif
4105 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4106 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4107 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4108 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4109 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4113 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4114 in *IEVENT. */
4116 static void
4117 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4119 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4120 Lisp_Object window;
4121 struct frame *f;
4122 struct window *w;
4124 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4125 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4127 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4128 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4130 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4131 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4132 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4133 #ifdef USE_GTK
4134 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4135 #else
4136 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4137 #endif
4138 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4139 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4140 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4141 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4142 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4146 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4148 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4150 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4153 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4154 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4155 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4157 static void
4158 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4160 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4161 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4162 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4164 switch (cs->reason)
4166 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4167 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4168 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4169 break;
4171 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4172 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4173 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4174 break;
4176 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4177 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4178 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4179 break;
4181 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4182 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4183 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4184 break;
4186 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4187 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4188 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4189 break;
4191 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4192 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4193 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4194 break;
4196 case XmCR_DRAG:
4198 int slider_size;
4200 /* Get the slider size. */
4201 BLOCK_INPUT;
4202 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4203 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4205 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4206 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4207 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4208 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4210 break;
4212 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4213 break;
4216 if (part >= 0)
4218 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4219 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4220 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4224 #elif defined USE_GTK
4226 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4227 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4229 static gboolean
4230 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4231 GtkScrollType scroll,
4232 gdouble value,
4233 gpointer user_data)
4235 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4236 gdouble position;
4237 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4238 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4239 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4241 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4242 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4245 switch (scroll)
4247 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4248 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4249 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4250 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4252 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4253 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4254 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4255 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4256 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4258 break;
4259 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4260 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4261 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4262 break;
4263 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4264 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4265 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4266 break;
4267 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4268 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4269 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4270 break;
4271 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4272 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4273 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4274 break;
4277 if (part >= 0)
4279 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4280 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4281 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4284 return FALSE;
4287 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4289 static gboolean
4290 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4291 GdkEventButton *event,
4292 gpointer user_data)
4294 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4295 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4296 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4298 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4299 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4300 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4303 return FALSE;
4307 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4309 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4310 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4311 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4312 the thumb is. */
4314 static void
4315 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4317 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4318 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4319 float shown;
4320 int whole, portion, height;
4321 int part;
4323 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4324 BLOCK_INPUT;
4325 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4326 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4328 whole = 10000000;
4329 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4331 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4332 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4333 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4334 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4335 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4336 bottom). */
4337 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4338 else
4339 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4341 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4342 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4343 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4344 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4348 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4349 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4350 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4351 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4352 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4353 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4354 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4356 static void
4357 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4359 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4360 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4361 int position = (long) call_data;
4362 Dimension height;
4363 int part;
4365 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4366 BLOCK_INPUT;
4367 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4370 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4371 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4373 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4374 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4375 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4376 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4377 else
4378 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4380 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4381 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4382 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4383 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4386 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4388 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4390 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4391 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4393 #ifdef USE_GTK
4394 static void
4395 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4397 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4399 BLOCK_INPUT;
4400 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4401 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4402 scroll_bar_name);
4403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4406 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4408 static void
4409 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4411 Window xwindow;
4412 Widget widget;
4413 Arg av[20];
4414 int ac = 0;
4415 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4416 unsigned long pixel;
4418 BLOCK_INPUT;
4420 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4421 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4422 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4425 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4426 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4427 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4428 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4430 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4431 if (pixel != -1)
4433 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4434 ++ac;
4437 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4438 if (pixel != -1)
4440 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4441 ++ac;
4444 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4445 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4447 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4448 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4449 (XtPointer) bar);
4450 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4451 (XtPointer) bar);
4452 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4453 (XtPointer) bar);
4454 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4455 (XtPointer) bar);
4456 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4457 (XtPointer) bar);
4458 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4459 (XtPointer) bar);
4460 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4461 (XtPointer) bar);
4463 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4464 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4466 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4467 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4468 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4469 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4471 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4473 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4474 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4475 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4476 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4477 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4478 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4479 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4480 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4482 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4483 if (pixel != -1)
4485 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4486 ++ac;
4489 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4490 if (pixel != -1)
4492 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4493 ++ac;
4496 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4498 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4499 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4501 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4502 if (pixel != -1)
4504 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4505 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4506 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4507 pixel = -1;
4508 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4511 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4513 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4514 if (pixel != -1)
4516 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4517 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4518 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4519 pixel = -1;
4520 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4524 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4525 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4526 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4527 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4528 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4529 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4530 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4531 colors itself. */
4533 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4534 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4535 ++ac;
4537 else
4538 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4539 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4540 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4542 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4543 the shadows. */
4544 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4545 ++ac;
4547 /* Specify the colors. */
4548 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4549 if (pixel != -1)
4551 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4552 ++ac;
4554 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4555 if (pixel != -1)
4557 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4558 ++ac;
4561 #endif
4563 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4564 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4567 char *initial = "";
4568 char *val = initial;
4569 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4570 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4571 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4572 #endif
4573 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4574 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4575 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4576 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4577 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4578 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4582 /* Define callbacks. */
4583 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4584 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4585 (XtPointer) bar);
4587 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4588 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4590 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4592 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4593 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4594 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4595 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4597 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4598 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4599 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4600 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4602 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4604 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4607 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4608 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4610 #ifdef USE_GTK
4611 static void
4612 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4614 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4617 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4618 static void
4619 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4620 int whole)
4622 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4623 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4624 float top, shown;
4626 BLOCK_INPUT;
4628 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4630 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4631 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4632 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4633 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4634 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4635 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4636 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4637 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4638 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4639 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4640 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4641 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4642 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4643 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4644 whole += portion;
4646 if (whole <= 0)
4647 top = 0, shown = 1;
4648 else
4650 top = (float) position / whole;
4651 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4654 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4656 int size, value;
4658 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4659 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4660 value. */
4661 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4662 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4663 size = max (size, 1);
4665 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4666 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4667 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4669 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4671 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4673 if (whole == 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4682 float old_top, old_shown;
4683 Dimension height;
4684 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4685 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4686 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4687 XtNheight, &height,
4688 NULL);
4690 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4691 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4692 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4693 else
4694 top = old_top;
4695 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4696 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4698 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4699 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4700 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4701 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4703 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4704 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4705 else
4707 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4708 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4709 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4711 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4715 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4717 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4719 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4721 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4725 /************************************************************************
4726 Scroll bars, general
4727 ************************************************************************/
4729 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4730 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4731 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4732 scroll bar. */
4734 static struct scroll_bar *
4735 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4737 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4738 struct scroll_bar *bar
4739 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4741 BLOCK_INPUT;
4743 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4744 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4745 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4747 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4748 unsigned long mask;
4749 Window window;
4751 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4752 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4753 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4755 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4756 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4757 | ExposureMask);
4758 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4760 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4762 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4763 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4764 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4765 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4766 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4767 left, top, width,
4768 window_box_height (w), False);
4770 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4771 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4772 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4773 top,
4774 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4775 height,
4776 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4778 CopyFromParent,
4779 CopyFromParent,
4780 CopyFromParent,
4781 /* Attributes. */
4782 mask, &a);
4783 bar->x_window = window;
4785 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4787 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4788 bar->top = top;
4789 bar->left = left;
4790 bar->width = width;
4791 bar->height = height;
4792 bar->start = 0;
4793 bar->end = 0;
4794 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4795 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4797 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4798 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4799 bar->prev = Qnil;
4800 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4801 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4802 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4804 /* Map the window/widget. */
4805 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4807 #ifdef USE_GTK
4808 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4809 bar->x_window,
4810 top,
4811 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4812 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4813 max (height, 1));
4814 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4815 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4816 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4817 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4818 top,
4819 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4820 max (height, 1), 0);
4821 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4822 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4824 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4825 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4826 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4829 return bar;
4833 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4835 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4837 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4838 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4839 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4840 events.)
4842 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4843 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4844 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4845 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4846 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4848 static void
4849 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4851 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4852 Window w = bar->x_window;
4853 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4854 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4856 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4857 if (! rebuild
4858 && start == bar->start
4859 && end == bar->end)
4860 return;
4862 BLOCK_INPUT;
4865 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4866 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4867 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4869 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4870 the distance between start and end. */
4872 int length = end - start;
4874 if (start < 0)
4875 start = 0;
4876 else if (start > top_range)
4877 start = top_range;
4878 end = start + length;
4880 if (end < start)
4881 end = start;
4882 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4883 end = top_range;
4886 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4887 bar->start = start;
4888 bar->end = end;
4890 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4891 if (end > top_range)
4892 end = top_range;
4894 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4895 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4896 that many pixels tall. */
4897 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4899 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4900 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4901 if (0 < start)
4902 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4903 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4904 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4905 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4906 inside_width, start,
4907 False);
4909 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4910 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4911 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4912 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4914 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4915 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4916 /* x, y, width, height */
4917 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4918 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4919 inside_width, end - start);
4921 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4922 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4923 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4924 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
4926 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4927 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4928 if (end < inside_height)
4929 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4930 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4931 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4932 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4933 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4934 False);
4938 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4941 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4943 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4944 nil. */
4946 static void
4947 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
4949 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4950 BLOCK_INPUT;
4952 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4953 #ifdef USE_GTK
4954 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
4955 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4956 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4957 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4958 #else
4959 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4960 #endif
4962 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4963 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4965 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4969 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4970 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4971 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4972 create one. */
4974 static void
4975 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
4977 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4978 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4979 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4980 int window_y, window_height;
4981 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4982 int fringe_extended_p;
4983 #endif
4985 /* Get window dimensions. */
4986 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4987 top = window_y;
4988 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4989 height = window_height;
4991 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
4992 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
4994 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
4995 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
4996 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
4997 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
4998 else
4999 sb_width = width;
5001 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5002 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5003 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5004 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5005 else
5006 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5007 #else
5008 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5009 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5010 else
5011 sb_left = left;
5012 #endif
5014 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5015 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5016 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5017 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5018 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5019 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5020 else
5021 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5022 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5023 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5024 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5025 #endif
5027 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5028 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5030 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5032 BLOCK_INPUT;
5033 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5034 if (fringe_extended_p)
5035 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5036 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5037 else
5038 #endif
5039 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5040 left, top, width, height, False);
5041 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5044 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5046 else
5048 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5049 unsigned int mask = 0;
5051 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5053 BLOCK_INPUT;
5055 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5056 mask |= CWX;
5057 if (top != bar->top)
5058 mask |= CWY;
5059 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5060 mask |= CWWidth;
5061 if (height != bar->height)
5062 mask |= CWHeight;
5064 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5066 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5067 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5069 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5070 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5071 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5073 if (fringe_extended_p)
5074 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5075 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5076 else
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5080 #ifdef USE_GTK
5081 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5082 bar->x_window,
5083 top,
5084 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5085 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5086 max (height, 1));
5087 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5088 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5089 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5090 top,
5091 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5092 max (height, 1), 0);
5093 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5095 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5097 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5098 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5099 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5101 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5102 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5103 height, False);
5104 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5105 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5106 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5107 height, False);
5110 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5111 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5112 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5113 example. */
5115 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5116 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5117 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5119 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5120 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5121 left + area_width - rest, top,
5122 rest, height, False);
5123 else
5124 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5125 left, top, rest, height, False);
5129 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5130 if (mask)
5132 XWindowChanges wc;
5134 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5135 wc.y = top;
5136 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5137 wc.height = height;
5138 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5139 mask, &wc);
5142 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5144 /* Remember new settings. */
5145 bar->left = sb_left;
5146 bar->top = top;
5147 bar->width = sb_width;
5148 bar->height = height;
5150 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5153 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5154 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5156 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5157 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5158 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5159 dragged. */
5160 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5162 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5164 if (whole == 0)
5165 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5166 else
5168 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5169 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5170 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5173 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5175 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5179 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5180 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5181 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5182 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5183 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5184 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5185 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5187 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5188 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5189 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5191 static void
5192 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5194 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5195 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5197 Lisp_Object bar;
5198 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5199 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5200 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5201 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5202 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5203 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5204 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5209 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5210 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5212 static void
5213 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5215 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5216 struct frame *f;
5218 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5219 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5220 abort ();
5222 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5224 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5225 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5226 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5228 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5229 the lists. */
5230 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5231 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5232 return;
5233 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5234 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5236 else
5237 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5238 one or the other! */
5239 abort ();
5241 else
5242 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5244 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5245 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5247 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5248 bar->prev = Qnil;
5249 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5250 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5251 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5254 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5255 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5257 static void
5258 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5260 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5262 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5264 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5265 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5266 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5268 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5270 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5272 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5274 next = b->next;
5275 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5278 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5279 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5283 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5284 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5285 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5287 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5288 mark bits. */
5290 static void
5291 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5293 Window w = bar->x_window;
5294 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5295 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5296 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5298 BLOCK_INPUT;
5300 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5302 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5303 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5304 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5305 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5307 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5308 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5310 /* x, y, width, height */
5311 0, 0,
5312 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5313 bar->height - 1);
5315 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5316 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5317 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5318 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5320 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5323 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5325 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5326 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5328 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5329 mark bits. */
5332 static void
5333 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5335 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5336 abort ();
5338 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5339 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5340 emacs_event->modifiers
5341 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5342 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5343 event->xbutton.state)
5344 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5345 ? up_modifier
5346 : down_modifier));
5347 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5348 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5349 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5351 int top_range
5352 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5353 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5355 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5356 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5358 if (y < bar->start)
5359 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5360 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5361 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5362 else
5363 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5365 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5366 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5367 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5368 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5370 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5371 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5373 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5376 #endif
5378 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5379 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5383 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5385 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5387 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5388 mark bits. */
5390 static void
5391 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5393 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5395 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5397 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5398 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5400 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5401 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5403 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5404 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5406 if (new_start != bar->start)
5408 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5410 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5415 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5417 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5418 on the scroll bar. */
5420 static void
5421 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window, enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *time)
5423 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5424 Window w = bar->x_window;
5425 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5426 int win_x, win_y;
5427 Window dummy_window;
5428 int dummy_coord;
5429 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5431 BLOCK_INPUT;
5433 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5434 report that. */
5435 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5437 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5438 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5439 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5441 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5442 &win_x, &win_y,
5444 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5445 &dummy_mask))
5447 else
5449 int top_range
5450 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5452 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5454 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5455 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5457 if (win_y < 0)
5458 win_y = 0;
5459 if (win_y > top_range)
5460 win_y = top_range;
5462 *fp = f;
5463 *bar_window = bar->window;
5465 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5466 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5467 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5468 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5469 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5470 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5471 else
5472 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5474 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5475 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5477 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5478 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5481 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5483 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5487 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5488 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5489 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5490 redraw them. */
5492 void
5493 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5495 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5496 Lisp_Object bar;
5498 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5499 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5500 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5501 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5502 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5503 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5504 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5505 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5506 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5507 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5511 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5513 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5514 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5515 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5516 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5518 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5519 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5521 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5523 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5524 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5526 static int temp_index;
5527 static short temp_buffer[100];
5529 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5530 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5531 temp_index = 0; \
5532 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5534 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5535 on a particular display. */
5537 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5539 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5540 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5541 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5542 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5544 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5546 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5547 do \
5549 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5550 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5551 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5552 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5553 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5554 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5556 while (0)
5558 enum
5560 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5561 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5562 X_EVENT_DROP
5565 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5566 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5567 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5569 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5570 this event further.
5571 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5573 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5574 static int
5575 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5577 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5578 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5579 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5580 was created. */
5582 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5583 event->xclient.window);
5585 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5587 #endif
5589 #ifdef USE_GTK
5590 static int current_count;
5591 static int current_finish;
5592 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5594 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5595 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5596 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5597 static GdkFilterReturn
5598 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5600 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5602 BLOCK_INPUT;
5603 if (current_count >= 0)
5605 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5607 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5609 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5610 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5611 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5612 so we do it here. */
5613 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5614 && dpyinfo
5615 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5618 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5620 #endif
5622 if (! dpyinfo)
5623 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5624 else
5625 current_count +=
5626 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5627 current_hold_quit);
5629 else
5630 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5634 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5635 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5637 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5639 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5642 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5644 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5645 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5646 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5648 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5650 static int
5651 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventp, int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5653 union {
5654 struct input_event ie;
5655 struct selection_input_event sie;
5656 } inev;
5657 int count = 0;
5658 int do_help = 0;
5659 int nbytes = 0;
5660 struct frame *f = NULL;
5661 struct coding_system coding;
5662 XEvent event = *eventp;
5664 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5666 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5667 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5668 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5670 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5671 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5673 switch (event.type)
5675 case ClientMessage:
5677 if (event.xclient.message_type
5678 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5679 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5681 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5682 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5684 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5685 could be the shell widget window
5686 if the frame has no title bar. */
5687 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5688 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5689 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5690 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5691 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5692 #endif
5693 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5694 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5695 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5696 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5697 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5698 needed.
5700 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5701 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5702 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5703 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5704 Emacs. */
5706 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5707 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5708 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5709 if (f)
5711 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5712 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5713 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5714 x_catch_errors (d);
5715 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5716 /* The ICCCM says this is
5717 the only valid choice. */
5718 RevertToParent,
5719 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5720 /* This is needed to detect the error
5721 if there is an error. */
5722 XSync (d, False);
5723 x_uncatch_errors ();
5725 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5726 #endif /* 0 */
5727 goto done;
5730 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5731 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5733 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5734 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5735 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5736 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5737 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5738 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5739 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5740 session manager and one for this. */
5741 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5742 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5743 #endif
5745 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5746 event.xclient.window);
5747 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5748 for a single Emacs process. */
5749 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5750 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5751 event.xclient.window,
5752 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5753 else if (f)
5754 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5755 event.xclient.window,
5756 0, 0);
5758 goto done;
5761 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5762 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5765 event.xclient.window);
5766 if (!f)
5767 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5769 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5771 goto done;
5774 goto done;
5777 if (event.xclient.message_type
5778 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5780 goto done;
5783 if (event.xclient.message_type
5784 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5786 int new_x, new_y;
5787 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5789 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5790 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5792 if (f)
5794 f->left_pos = new_x;
5795 f->top_pos = new_y;
5797 goto done;
5800 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5801 if (event.xclient.message_type
5802 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5804 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5805 if (f)
5806 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5807 &event, NULL);
5808 goto done;
5810 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5812 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5813 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5814 || (event.xclient.message_type
5815 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5817 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5818 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5819 currently never do because we are interested in
5820 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5821 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5822 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5823 if (!f)
5824 goto OTHER;
5825 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5826 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5827 goto done;
5830 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5831 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5832 we construct an input_event. */
5833 if (event.xclient.message_type
5834 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5836 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5837 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5838 goto done;
5840 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5842 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5843 if (event.xclient.message_type
5844 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5846 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5847 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5848 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5850 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5851 goto done;
5854 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5856 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5857 if (!f)
5858 goto OTHER;
5859 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5860 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5862 break;
5864 case SelectionNotify:
5865 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5866 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5867 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5868 goto OTHER;
5869 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5870 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5871 break;
5873 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5874 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
5875 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5876 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5877 goto OTHER;
5878 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5880 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5882 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5883 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5884 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5885 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5886 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5888 break;
5890 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5891 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
5892 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5893 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5894 goto OTHER;
5895 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5897 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5898 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5900 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5901 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
5902 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
5903 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
5904 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
5905 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
5906 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
5907 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5909 break;
5911 case PropertyNotify:
5912 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
5913 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
5914 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
5915 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
5917 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5918 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5919 goto OTHER;
5921 case ReparentNotify:
5922 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5923 if (f)
5925 int x, y;
5926 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5927 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5928 f->left_pos = x;
5929 f->top_pos = y;
5931 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5932 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5933 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
5935 goto OTHER;
5937 case Expose:
5938 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5939 if (f)
5941 #ifdef USE_GTK
5942 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
5943 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
5944 event.xexpose.window,
5945 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5946 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
5947 FALSE);
5948 #endif
5949 if (f->async_visible == 0)
5951 f->async_visible = 1;
5952 f->async_iconified = 0;
5953 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
5954 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
5956 else
5957 expose_frame (f,
5958 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
5959 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
5961 else
5963 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5964 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5965 #endif
5966 #if defined USE_LUCID
5967 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
5968 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
5969 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
5971 Widget widget
5972 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
5973 if (widget)
5974 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
5976 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
5978 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5979 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
5980 goto OTHER;
5981 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5982 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
5983 event.xexpose.window);
5985 if (bar)
5986 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
5987 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5988 else
5989 goto OTHER;
5990 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5991 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5993 break;
5995 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
5996 source area was obscured or not
5997 available. */
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
5999 if (f)
6001 expose_frame (f,
6002 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6003 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6004 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6006 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6007 else
6008 goto OTHER;
6009 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6010 break;
6012 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6013 source area was completely
6014 available. */
6015 break;
6017 case UnmapNotify:
6018 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6019 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6021 tip_window = 0;
6022 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6025 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6026 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6027 the frame was deleted. */
6029 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6030 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6031 display that won't ever be seen. */
6032 f->async_visible = 0;
6033 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6034 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6035 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6036 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6037 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6038 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6039 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6041 f->async_iconified = 1;
6043 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6044 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6047 goto OTHER;
6049 case MapNotify:
6050 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6051 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6052 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6053 goto OTHER;
6055 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6056 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6057 frame is visible. */
6058 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6059 if (f)
6061 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6062 the frame's display structures.
6063 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6064 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6065 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6066 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6067 if (! f->async_iconified)
6068 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6070 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6071 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6072 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6073 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6075 f->async_visible = 1;
6076 f->async_iconified = 0;
6077 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6079 if (f->iconified)
6081 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6082 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6084 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6085 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6086 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6087 to update the frame titles
6088 in case this is the second frame. */
6089 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6091 #ifdef USE_GTK
6092 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6093 #endif
6095 goto OTHER;
6097 case KeyPress:
6099 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6100 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6102 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6103 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6104 if (popup_activated ())
6105 goto OTHER;
6106 #endif
6108 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6110 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6111 mouse highlighting. */
6112 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6113 && (f == 0
6114 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6116 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6117 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6120 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6121 if (f == 0)
6123 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6124 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6125 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6126 event.xkey.window);
6127 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6129 widget = XtParent (widget);
6130 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6133 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6135 if (f != 0)
6137 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6138 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6139 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6140 his Emacs hang.
6142 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6143 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6144 status_return even if the input is too long to
6145 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6146 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6147 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6148 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6149 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6150 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6151 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6152 int modifiers;
6153 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6154 Lisp_Object c;
6156 #ifdef USE_GTK
6157 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6158 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6159 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6160 (see above). */
6161 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6162 #endif
6164 event.xkey.state
6165 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6166 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6167 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6169 /* This will have to go some day... */
6171 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6172 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6173 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6174 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6175 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6176 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6177 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6179 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6180 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6181 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6182 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6183 not it is combined with Meta. */
6184 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6185 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6187 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6188 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6190 Status status_return;
6192 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6193 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6194 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6195 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6196 &status_return);
6197 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6199 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6200 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6201 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6202 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6203 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6204 &status_return);
6206 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6207 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6208 break;
6209 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6211 keysym = NoSymbol;
6212 modifiers = 0;
6214 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6215 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6216 abort ();
6218 else
6219 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6220 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6221 &compose_status);
6222 #else
6223 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6224 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6225 &compose_status);
6226 #endif
6228 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6229 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6230 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6231 break;
6233 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6234 orig_keysym = keysym;
6236 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6237 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6238 inev.ie.modifiers
6239 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6240 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6242 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6243 translations to characters. */
6244 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6245 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6247 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6248 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6249 goto done_keysym;
6252 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6253 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6255 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6256 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6257 else
6258 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6259 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6260 goto done_keysym;
6263 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6264 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6265 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6266 Vx_keysym_table,
6267 Qnil))))
6269 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6270 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6271 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6272 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6273 goto done_keysym;
6276 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6277 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6278 || keysym == XK_Delete
6279 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6280 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6281 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6282 #endif
6283 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6284 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6285 #ifdef HPUX
6286 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6287 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6288 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6289 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6290 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6291 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6292 #endif
6293 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6294 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6295 #endif
6296 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6297 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6298 #endif
6299 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6300 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6301 #endif
6302 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6303 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6304 #endif
6305 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6306 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6307 #endif
6308 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6309 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6310 #endif
6311 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6312 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6313 #endif
6314 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6315 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6316 #endif
6317 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6318 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6319 #endif
6320 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6321 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6322 #endif
6323 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6324 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6325 #endif
6326 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6327 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6328 #endif
6329 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6330 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6331 #endif
6332 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6333 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6334 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6335 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6336 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6337 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6338 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6339 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6340 don't have real modifiers but
6341 should be treated similarly to
6342 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6343 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6344 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6345 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6346 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6347 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6348 #endif
6351 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6352 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6353 key. */
6354 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6355 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6356 goto done_keysym;
6359 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6360 register int i;
6361 register int c;
6362 int nchars, len;
6364 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6366 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6367 nchars++;
6368 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6371 if (nchars < nbytes)
6373 /* Decode the input data. */
6374 int require;
6375 unsigned char *p;
6377 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6378 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6379 we used just above and the locale. */
6380 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6381 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6382 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6383 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6384 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6385 gives us composition information. */
6386 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6388 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6389 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6390 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6391 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6392 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6393 nbytes = coding.produced;
6394 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6395 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6398 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6399 character events. */
6400 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6402 if (nchars == nbytes)
6403 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6404 else
6405 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6406 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6407 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6408 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6409 inev.ie.code = c;
6410 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6413 count += nchars;
6415 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6417 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6418 break;
6421 done_keysym:
6422 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6423 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6424 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6425 client. */
6426 break;
6427 #else
6428 goto OTHER;
6429 #endif
6431 case KeyRelease:
6432 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6433 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6434 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6435 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6436 client. */
6437 break;
6438 #else
6439 goto OTHER;
6440 #endif
6442 case EnterNotify:
6443 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6444 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6446 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6448 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6449 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6451 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6452 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6453 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6454 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6455 #ifdef USE_GTK
6456 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6457 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6458 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6459 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6460 #endif
6461 goto OTHER;
6463 case FocusIn:
6464 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6465 goto OTHER;
6467 case LeaveNotify:
6468 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6469 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6471 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6472 if (f)
6474 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6476 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6477 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6478 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6479 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6482 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6483 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6484 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6485 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6486 if (any_help_event_p)
6487 do_help = -1;
6489 #ifdef USE_GTK
6490 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6491 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6492 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6493 #endif
6494 goto OTHER;
6496 case FocusOut:
6497 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6498 goto OTHER;
6500 case MotionNotify:
6502 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6503 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6504 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6506 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6507 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6508 f = last_mouse_frame;
6509 else
6510 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6512 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6514 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6515 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6518 #ifdef USE_GTK
6519 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6520 f = 0;
6521 #endif
6522 if (f)
6525 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6526 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6527 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6529 Lisp_Object window;
6531 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6532 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6533 0, 0, 0, 0);
6535 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6536 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6537 will be selected only when it is active. */
6538 if (WINDOWP (window)
6539 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6540 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6541 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6542 create event iff we don't leave the
6543 selected frame. */
6544 && (focus_follows_mouse
6545 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6546 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6548 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6549 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6552 last_window=window;
6554 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6555 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6557 else
6559 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6560 struct scroll_bar *bar
6561 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6562 event.xmotion.window);
6564 if (bar)
6565 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6566 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6568 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6569 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6570 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6573 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6574 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6575 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6576 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6577 do_help = 1;
6578 goto OTHER;
6581 case ConfigureNotify:
6582 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6583 #ifdef USE_GTK
6584 if (!f
6585 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6586 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6588 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6589 event.xconfigure.height);
6590 f = 0;
6592 #endif
6593 if (f)
6595 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6596 #ifndef USE_GTK
6597 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6598 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6600 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6601 is called by the code that handles resizing
6602 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6604 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6605 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6606 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6607 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6608 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6609 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6610 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6612 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6613 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6614 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6617 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6618 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6619 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6620 #endif
6622 #ifdef USE_GTK
6623 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6624 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6625 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6626 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6627 #endif
6629 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6632 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6633 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6634 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6635 #endif
6638 goto OTHER;
6640 case ButtonRelease:
6641 case ButtonPress:
6643 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6644 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6645 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6647 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6648 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6649 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6651 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6652 && last_mouse_frame
6653 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6654 f = last_mouse_frame;
6655 else
6656 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6658 #ifdef USE_GTK
6659 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6660 f = 0;
6661 #endif
6662 if (f)
6664 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6665 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6666 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6668 Lisp_Object window;
6669 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6670 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6672 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6673 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6675 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6677 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6678 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6679 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6680 event.xbutton.state));
6684 if (!tool_bar_p)
6685 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6686 if (! popup_activated ())
6687 #endif
6689 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6691 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6692 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6694 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6695 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6697 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6698 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6700 else
6701 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6703 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6704 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6705 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6707 else
6709 struct scroll_bar *bar
6710 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6711 event.xbutton.window);
6713 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6714 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6715 scroll bars. */
6716 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6718 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6719 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6721 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6722 if (bar)
6723 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6724 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6727 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6729 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6730 last_mouse_frame = f;
6732 if (!tool_bar_p)
6733 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6735 else
6736 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6738 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6739 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6740 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6741 if (f != 0)
6742 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6744 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6745 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6746 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6747 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6748 Instead, save it away
6749 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6750 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6751 if (! popup_activated ()
6752 #ifdef USE_GTK
6753 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6754 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6755 #endif
6756 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6757 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6758 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6759 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6760 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6761 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6762 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6763 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6765 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6766 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6767 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6769 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6771 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6772 goto OTHER;
6774 else
6775 goto OTHER;
6776 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6778 break;
6780 case CirculateNotify:
6781 goto OTHER;
6783 case CirculateRequest:
6784 goto OTHER;
6786 case VisibilityNotify:
6787 goto OTHER;
6789 case MappingNotify:
6790 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6791 local cache. */
6792 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6794 case MappingModifier:
6795 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6796 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6797 case MappingKeyboard:
6798 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6800 goto OTHER;
6802 case DestroyNotify:
6803 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6804 break;
6806 default:
6807 OTHER:
6808 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6809 BLOCK_INPUT;
6810 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6811 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6813 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6814 break;
6817 done:
6818 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6820 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6821 count++;
6824 if (do_help
6825 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6827 Lisp_Object frame;
6829 if (f)
6830 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6831 else
6832 frame = Qnil;
6834 if (do_help > 0)
6836 any_help_event_p = 1;
6837 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6838 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6840 else
6842 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6843 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6845 count++;
6848 *eventp = event;
6849 return count;
6853 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6854 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6855 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6857 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6859 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6861 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6862 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6864 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6866 if (dpyinfo)
6867 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6869 return finish;
6873 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6874 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6875 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6877 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6878 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
6879 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
6880 C chars).
6882 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6884 static int
6885 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
6887 int count = 0;
6888 XEvent event;
6889 int event_found = 0;
6891 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6893 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6894 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6895 pending_signals = 1;
6896 #endif
6897 return -1;
6900 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6901 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
6902 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
6903 #endif
6904 BLOCK_INPUT;
6906 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6907 input_signal_count++;
6909 ++handling_signal;
6911 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
6912 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
6913 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
6915 struct input_event inev;
6916 BLOCK_INPUT;
6917 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
6918 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
6919 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
6921 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6922 count++;
6924 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6926 #endif
6928 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
6929 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
6931 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
6932 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
6935 #ifndef USE_GTK
6936 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
6938 int finish;
6940 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
6942 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6943 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
6944 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
6945 continue;
6946 #endif
6947 event_found = 1;
6949 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
6950 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
6952 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
6953 goto out;
6956 #else /* USE_GTK */
6958 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
6959 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
6960 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
6961 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
6963 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
6964 from all displays. */
6966 while (gtk_events_pending ())
6968 current_count = count;
6969 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
6971 gtk_main_iteration ();
6973 count = current_count;
6974 current_count = -1;
6975 current_hold_quit = 0;
6977 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
6978 break;
6980 #endif /* USE_GTK */
6982 out:;
6984 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
6985 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
6986 if (! event_found)
6988 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
6989 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
6990 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
6991 x_noop_count++;
6992 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
6994 x_noop_count=0;
6996 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
6997 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
6999 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7001 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7002 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7006 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7007 raise it now. */
7008 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7009 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7011 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7012 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7015 --handling_signal;
7016 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7018 return count;
7024 /***********************************************************************
7025 Text Cursor
7026 ***********************************************************************/
7028 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7029 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7031 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7032 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7033 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7035 static void
7036 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7038 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7039 XRectangle clip_rect;
7040 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7042 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7044 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7045 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7046 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7047 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7048 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7050 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7054 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7056 static void
7057 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7059 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7060 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7061 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7062 int x, y, wd, h;
7063 XGCValues xgcv;
7064 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7065 GC gc;
7067 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7068 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7069 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7070 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7071 return;
7073 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7074 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7075 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7077 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7078 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7079 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7080 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7081 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7082 else
7083 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7084 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7085 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7087 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7088 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7089 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7090 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7094 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7096 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7097 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7098 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7099 --gerd. */
7101 static void
7102 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7104 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7105 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7107 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7108 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7109 and mini-buffer. */
7110 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7111 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7112 return;
7114 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7115 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7116 the bar might not be in the window. */
7117 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7119 struct glyph_row *row;
7120 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7121 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7123 else
7125 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7126 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7127 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7128 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7129 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7130 XGCValues xgcv;
7132 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7133 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7134 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7135 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7136 that the glyph is legible. */
7137 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7138 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7139 else
7140 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7141 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7143 if (gc)
7144 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7145 else
7147 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7148 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7151 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7153 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7155 if (width < 0)
7156 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7157 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7159 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7161 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7162 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7163 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7164 width, row->height);
7166 else
7168 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7170 if (width < 0)
7171 width = row->height;
7173 width = min (row->height, width);
7175 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7176 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7178 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7179 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7180 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7181 row->height - width),
7182 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7185 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7190 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7192 static void
7193 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7195 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7196 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7197 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7198 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7202 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7204 static void
7205 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7207 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7208 x, y, width, height, False);
7209 #ifdef USE_GTK
7210 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7211 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7212 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7213 #endif
7217 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7219 static void
7220 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7222 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7224 if (on_p)
7226 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7227 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7229 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7230 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7231 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7232 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7234 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7235 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7237 else
7239 switch (cursor_type)
7241 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7242 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7243 break;
7245 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7246 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7247 break;
7249 case BAR_CURSOR:
7250 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7251 break;
7253 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7254 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7255 break;
7257 case NO_CURSOR:
7258 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7259 break;
7261 default:
7262 abort ();
7266 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7267 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7268 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7269 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7270 #endif
7273 #ifndef XFlush
7274 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7275 #endif
7279 /* Icons. */
7281 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7284 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7286 int bitmap_id;
7288 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7289 return 1;
7291 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7292 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7293 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7294 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7296 if (STRINGP (file))
7298 #ifdef USE_GTK
7299 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7300 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7301 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7302 return 0;
7303 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7304 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7305 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7307 else
7309 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7310 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7312 int rc = -1;
7314 #ifdef USE_GTK
7316 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7317 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7318 return 0;
7320 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7322 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7323 if (rc != -1)
7324 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7326 #endif
7328 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7329 if (rc == -1)
7331 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7332 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7333 if (rc == -1)
7334 return 1;
7336 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7337 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7341 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7342 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7343 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7344 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7345 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7347 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7350 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7351 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7353 return 0;
7357 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7358 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7361 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7363 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7364 return 1;
7367 XTextProperty text;
7368 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7369 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7370 text.format = 8;
7371 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7372 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7375 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7376 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7377 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7378 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7380 return 0;
7383 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7385 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7386 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7388 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7389 be called from a signal handler.
7392 struct x_error_message_stack {
7393 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7394 Display *dpy;
7395 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7397 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7399 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7400 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7401 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7403 static void
7404 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7406 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7407 x_error_message->string,
7408 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7411 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7412 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7413 operating on.
7415 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7416 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7417 stored in *x_error_message.
7419 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7420 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7422 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7424 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7426 void
7427 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7429 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7431 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7432 XSync (dpy, False);
7434 data->dpy = dpy;
7435 data->string[0] = 0;
7436 data->prev = x_error_message;
7437 x_error_message = data;
7440 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7441 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7443 void
7444 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7446 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7448 BLOCK_INPUT;
7450 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7451 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7452 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7453 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7455 tmp = x_error_message;
7456 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7457 xfree (tmp);
7458 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7461 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7462 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7463 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7465 void
7466 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7468 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7469 XSync (dpy, False);
7471 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7473 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7474 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7475 x_uncatch_errors ();
7476 error (format, string);
7480 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7481 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7484 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7486 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7487 XSync (dpy, False);
7489 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7492 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7494 void
7495 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7497 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7500 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7501 * idea. --lorentey */
7502 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7504 void
7505 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7507 while (x_error_message)
7508 x_uncatch_errors ();
7510 #endif
7512 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7515 x_catching_errors (void)
7517 return x_error_message != 0;
7520 #if 0
7521 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7522 x_trace_wire (void)
7524 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7526 #endif /* ! 0 */
7529 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7530 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7531 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7532 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7533 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7535 static SIGTYPE
7536 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7537 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7539 #ifdef USG
7540 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7541 must reestablish each time */
7542 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7543 #endif /* USG */
7547 /************************************************************************
7548 Handling X errors
7549 ************************************************************************/
7551 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7553 static char *error_msg;
7555 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7556 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7557 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7559 static void
7560 x_fatal_error_signal (void)
7562 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7563 exit (70);
7566 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7567 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7569 static SIGTYPE
7570 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7572 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7573 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7574 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7576 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7577 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7578 handling_signal = 0;
7580 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7581 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7582 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7583 the original message here. */
7584 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7586 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7587 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7589 if (dpyinfo)
7591 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7592 frame on it. */
7593 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7594 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7597 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7598 that are on the dead display. */
7599 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7601 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7602 minibuf_frame
7603 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7604 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7605 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7606 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7607 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7608 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7611 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7612 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7613 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7614 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7615 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7616 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7618 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7619 trying to find a replacement. */
7620 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7621 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7624 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7625 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7626 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7628 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7629 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7630 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7632 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7633 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7635 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7636 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7637 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7639 if (dpyinfo)
7641 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7642 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7643 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7645 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7646 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7647 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7649 #endif
7651 #ifdef USE_GTK
7652 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
7653 is the last display/terminal. */
7654 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
7656 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7657 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7658 /* NOTREACHED */
7660 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7661 #endif
7663 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7664 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7666 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7667 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7668 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7669 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7670 abort ();
7673 Lisp_Object tmp;
7674 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7675 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7679 x_uncatch_errors ();
7681 if (terminal_list == 0)
7683 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7684 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7685 /* NOTREACHED */
7688 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7689 #ifdef SIGIO
7690 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7691 #endif
7692 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7693 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7695 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7696 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7697 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7698 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7699 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7700 error ("%s", error_msg);
7703 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7704 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7705 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7707 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7708 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7710 static int
7711 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7713 if (x_error_message)
7714 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7715 else
7716 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7717 return 0;
7720 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7721 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7722 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7724 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7726 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7727 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7728 #else
7729 #define NO_INLINE
7730 #endif
7732 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7734 #ifdef noinline
7735 #undef noinline
7736 #endif
7738 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7739 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7741 static void NO_INLINE
7742 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *error)
7744 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7746 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7747 or colors that are not defined. */
7749 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7750 return;
7752 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7753 original error handler. */
7755 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7756 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7757 buf, error->request_code);
7758 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7762 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7763 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7764 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7766 static int
7767 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7769 char buf[256];
7771 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7772 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7773 return 0;
7776 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7778 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7779 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7780 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7781 FONT-OBJECT. */
7783 Lisp_Object
7784 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7786 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7788 if (fontset < 0)
7789 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7790 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7791 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7792 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7793 do. */
7794 return font_object;
7796 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7797 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7798 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7799 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7800 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7802 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7804 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7805 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7807 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7808 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7809 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7811 else
7813 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7814 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7817 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7819 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7820 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7821 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7822 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7823 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7826 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7827 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7828 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7830 BLOCK_INPUT;
7831 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7832 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7834 #endif
7836 return font_object;
7840 /***********************************************************************
7841 X Input Methods
7842 ***********************************************************************/
7844 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7846 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7848 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7849 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7850 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7852 static void
7853 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7855 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7856 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7858 BLOCK_INPUT;
7860 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7861 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7863 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7864 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7866 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7867 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7871 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7872 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7873 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7874 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7877 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7879 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7880 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7881 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7882 #endif
7884 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7885 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7887 static void
7888 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7890 XIM xim;
7892 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7893 if (use_xim)
7895 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7896 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7897 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7898 emacs_class);
7899 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7901 if (xim)
7903 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7904 XIMCallback destroy;
7905 #endif
7907 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7908 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7910 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7911 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7912 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7913 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7914 #endif
7918 else
7919 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7920 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7924 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7926 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7927 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7928 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7929 when the callback was registered. */
7931 static void
7932 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7934 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
7935 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
7937 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
7938 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7939 return;
7941 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
7943 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
7944 as they have no XIC. */
7945 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
7947 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
7949 BLOCK_INPUT;
7950 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7952 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7954 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
7955 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
7956 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
7958 create_frame_xic (f);
7959 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
7960 xic_set_statusarea (f);
7961 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
7963 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
7964 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
7969 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7973 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
7976 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7977 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
7978 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
7979 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
7981 static void
7982 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7984 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7985 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7986 if (use_xim)
7988 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7989 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
7990 int len;
7992 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
7993 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
7994 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
7995 len = strlen (resource_name);
7996 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
7997 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
7998 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
7999 resource_name, emacs_class,
8000 xim_instantiate_callback,
8001 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8002 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8003 least, hence the configure test. */
8004 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8005 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8006 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8007 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8009 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8013 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8015 static void
8016 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8018 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8019 if (use_xim)
8021 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8022 if (dpyinfo->display)
8023 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8024 NULL, emacs_class,
8025 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8026 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8027 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8028 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8029 if (dpyinfo->display)
8030 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8031 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8032 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8034 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8037 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8041 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8042 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8044 void
8045 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8047 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8049 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8050 is already for the top-left corner. */
8051 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8052 return;
8054 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8055 position that fits on the screen. */
8056 if (flags & XNegative)
8057 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8058 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8061 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8063 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8064 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8065 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8067 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8068 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8069 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8070 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8071 is right, though.
8073 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8074 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8076 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8077 #endif
8079 if (flags & YNegative)
8080 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8081 - height + f->top_pos;
8084 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8085 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8086 so the flags should correspond. */
8087 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8090 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8091 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8092 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8093 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8094 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8096 void
8097 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8099 int modified_top, modified_left;
8101 if (change_gravity > 0)
8103 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8104 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8106 f->top_pos = yoff;
8107 f->left_pos = xoff;
8108 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8109 if (xoff < 0)
8110 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8111 if (yoff < 0)
8112 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8113 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8115 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8117 BLOCK_INPUT;
8118 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8120 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8121 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8123 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8125 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8126 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8127 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8128 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8129 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8132 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8133 modified_left, modified_top);
8135 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8136 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8137 ? 1 : 0);
8139 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8140 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8141 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8142 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8143 of the frame.
8145 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8146 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8147 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8149 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8150 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8151 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8152 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8153 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8154 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8156 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8159 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8160 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8161 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8162 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8163 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8165 static int
8166 wm_supports (struct frame *f, const char *atomname)
8168 Atom actual_type;
8169 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8170 int i, rc, actual_format;
8171 Atom prop_atom;
8172 Window wmcheck_window;
8173 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8174 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8175 long max_len = 65536;
8176 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8177 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8178 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8179 Atom want_atom;
8181 BLOCK_INPUT;
8183 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8185 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8186 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8187 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8188 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8189 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8191 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8193 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8194 x_uncatch_errors ();
8195 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8196 return 0;
8199 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8200 XFree (tmp_data);
8202 /* Check if window exists. */
8203 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8204 x_sync (f);
8205 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8207 x_uncatch_errors ();
8208 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8209 return 0;
8212 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8214 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8215 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8216 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8217 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8218 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8219 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8221 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8222 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8223 tmp_data = NULL;
8224 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8225 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8226 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8227 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8229 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8231 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8232 x_uncatch_errors ();
8233 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8234 return 0;
8237 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8238 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8239 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8242 rc = 0;
8243 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8245 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8246 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8248 x_uncatch_errors ();
8249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8251 return rc;
8254 static void
8255 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, const char *what, const char *what2)
8257 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8258 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8259 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8260 make_number (32),
8261 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8262 Fcons
8263 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8264 Fcons
8265 (make_unibyte_string (what, strlen (what)),
8266 what2 != 0
8267 ? Fcons (make_unibyte_string (what2, strlen (what2)),
8268 Qnil)
8269 : Qnil)));
8272 void
8273 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8275 Lisp_Object frame;
8277 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8278 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8279 "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", NULL);
8282 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8284 static int
8285 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8287 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8289 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8290 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8291 if (!have_net_atom)
8292 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8294 if (have_net_atom)
8296 Lisp_Object frame;
8297 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8298 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8299 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8301 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8303 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, NULL);
8304 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fh, NULL);
8305 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fw, NULL);
8307 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8308 hints. */
8309 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8311 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8312 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fs, NULL);
8313 break;
8314 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8315 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, NULL);
8316 break;
8317 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8318 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fh, NULL);
8319 break;
8320 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8321 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, fh);
8322 break;
8325 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8329 return have_net_atom;
8332 static void
8333 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8335 if (f->async_visible)
8337 BLOCK_INPUT;
8338 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8339 x_sync (f);
8340 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8345 static void
8346 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8348 Atom actual_type;
8349 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8350 int i, rc, actual_format, value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8351 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8352 long max_len = 65536;
8353 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8354 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8355 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8356 Lisp_Object lval;
8357 int sticky = 0;
8359 BLOCK_INPUT;
8360 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8361 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, event->window,
8362 event->atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8363 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8364 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8366 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8368 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8369 x_uncatch_errors ();
8370 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8371 return;
8374 x_uncatch_errors ();
8376 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8378 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8379 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8381 if (value == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8382 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8383 else
8384 value = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8386 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8388 if (value == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8389 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8390 else
8391 value = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8393 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom)
8394 value = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8395 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8396 sticky = 1;
8399 lval = Qnil;
8400 switch (value)
8402 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8403 lval = Qfullwidth;
8404 break;
8405 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8406 lval = Qfullheight;
8407 break;
8408 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8409 lval = Qfullboth;
8410 break;
8411 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8412 lval = Qmaximized;
8413 break;
8416 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8417 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8419 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8420 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8423 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8424 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8425 static void
8426 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8428 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8429 return;
8431 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8432 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8434 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8436 int width = FRAME_COLS (f), height = FRAME_LINES (f);
8437 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8439 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8441 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8442 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8443 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8444 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8445 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8446 break;
8447 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8448 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8449 break;
8450 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8451 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8454 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8456 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8457 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8458 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8463 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8464 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8465 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8466 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8467 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8468 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8469 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8471 static void
8472 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8474 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8476 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8477 window manager window around the frame. */
8479 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8481 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8483 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8485 int adjusted_left;
8486 int adjusted_top;
8488 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8489 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8490 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8492 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8494 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8495 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8497 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8498 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8500 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8502 else
8503 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8504 frame's position. */
8506 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8510 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8511 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8512 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8513 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8514 of an exact comparison. */
8516 static void
8517 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8519 int count = 0;
8521 while (count++ < 50)
8523 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8525 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8526 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8527 loop. */
8529 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8530 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8532 if (fuzzy)
8534 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8535 pixels. */
8537 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8538 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8539 return;
8541 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8542 return;
8545 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8546 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8548 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8552 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8553 void
8554 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8556 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8558 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8559 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8560 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8562 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8563 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8565 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8566 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8567 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8568 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8569 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8571 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8573 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8574 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8575 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8576 BLOCK_INPUT;
8577 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8579 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8580 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8582 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8583 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8585 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8586 break; /* Timeout */
8588 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8589 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8593 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8594 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8595 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8596 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8598 static void
8599 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8601 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8603 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8604 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8605 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8607 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8609 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8611 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8612 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8613 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8614 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8616 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8617 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8618 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8619 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8622 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8623 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8624 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8625 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8626 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8628 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8629 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8630 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8631 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8633 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8634 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8635 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8636 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8637 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8639 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8640 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8642 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8643 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8644 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8645 if (f->async_visible)
8646 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8647 else
8649 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8650 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8651 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8652 x_sync (f);
8657 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8658 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8659 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8660 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8662 void
8663 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8665 BLOCK_INPUT;
8667 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8669 int r, c;
8671 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8672 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8673 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8674 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8675 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8676 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8677 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8678 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8679 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8680 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8681 is however. */
8682 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8683 #endif
8684 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8685 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8686 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8687 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8688 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8689 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8690 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8693 #ifdef USE_GTK
8694 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8695 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8696 else
8697 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8698 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8700 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8702 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8704 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8705 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8707 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8708 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8709 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8710 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8711 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8716 /* Mouse warping. */
8718 void
8719 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8721 int pix_x, pix_y;
8723 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8724 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8726 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8727 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8729 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8730 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8732 BLOCK_INPUT;
8734 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8735 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8736 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8739 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8741 void
8742 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8744 BLOCK_INPUT;
8746 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8747 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8748 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8751 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8753 void
8754 x_focus_on_frame (struct frame *f)
8756 #if 0
8757 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8758 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8759 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8760 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8761 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8762 #endif /* ! 0 */
8765 void
8766 x_unfocus_frame (struct frame *f)
8768 #if 0
8769 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8770 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8771 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8772 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8773 #endif /* ! 0 */
8776 /* Raise frame F. */
8778 void
8779 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8781 BLOCK_INPUT;
8782 if (f->async_visible)
8783 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8785 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8786 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8789 /* Lower frame F. */
8791 void
8792 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8794 if (f->async_visible)
8796 BLOCK_INPUT;
8797 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8798 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8799 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8803 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8805 void
8806 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8808 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8809 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8811 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
8812 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
8814 Lisp_Object frame;
8815 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8816 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8817 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8818 make_number (32),
8819 Fcons (make_number (1),
8820 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8821 Qnil)));
8825 static void
8826 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8828 if (raise_flag)
8829 x_raise_frame (f);
8830 else
8831 x_lower_frame (f);
8834 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8836 void
8837 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8839 Atom atom;
8840 unsigned long data[2];
8842 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
8844 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8845 data[1] = flags;
8847 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
8848 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8851 void
8852 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time, enum xembed_message message, long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8854 XEvent event;
8856 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8857 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8858 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8859 event.xclient.format = 32;
8860 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
8861 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
8862 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8863 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8864 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8866 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8867 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8868 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8871 /* Change of visibility. */
8873 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8874 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8875 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8876 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8877 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8878 finishes with it. */
8880 void
8881 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8883 Lisp_Object type;
8884 int original_top, original_left;
8885 int retry_count = 2;
8887 retry:
8889 BLOCK_INPUT;
8891 type = x_icon_type (f);
8892 if (!NILP (type))
8893 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8895 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8897 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8898 call x_set_offset a second time
8899 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8900 before the window gets really visible. */
8901 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8902 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8903 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8904 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8906 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8908 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8909 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8910 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8911 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8912 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8913 else
8915 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8916 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8918 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8919 #ifdef USE_GTK
8920 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8921 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8922 #else
8923 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8924 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
8925 else
8926 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8927 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8928 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8931 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8933 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8934 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8935 so that incoming events are handled. */
8937 Lisp_Object frame;
8938 int count;
8939 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8940 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8941 will set it when they are handled. */
8942 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8944 original_left = f->left_pos;
8945 original_top = f->top_pos;
8947 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8948 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8950 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8952 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8953 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8954 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8955 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8957 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8958 because the window manager may choose the position
8959 and we don't want to override it. */
8961 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8962 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8963 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8964 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8965 && previously_visible)
8967 Drawable rootw;
8968 int x, y;
8969 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8971 BLOCK_INPUT;
8973 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8974 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8975 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8976 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8977 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8978 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8979 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8980 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8981 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8983 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8984 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8985 original_left, original_top);
8987 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8990 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8992 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8993 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8994 MapNotify at all.. */
8995 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8996 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8998 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8999 x_sync (f);
9001 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9002 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9003 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9004 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9005 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9006 probably a bug. */
9007 if (input_polling_used ())
9009 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9010 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9011 handler reset it. */
9012 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9013 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9014 poll_for_input_1 ();
9015 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9018 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9019 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9022 /* 2000-09-28: In
9024 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9025 (iconify-frame f)
9026 (raise-frame f))
9028 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9029 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9030 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9031 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9033 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9034 goto retry;
9038 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9040 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9042 void
9043 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9045 Window window;
9047 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9048 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9050 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9051 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9052 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9054 BLOCK_INPUT;
9056 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9057 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9058 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9059 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9060 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9061 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9063 #ifdef USE_GTK
9064 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9065 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9066 else
9067 #else
9068 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9069 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9070 else
9071 #endif
9074 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9075 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9077 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9078 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9082 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9083 just by the event that we get from the server.
9084 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9085 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9086 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9087 f->visible = 0;
9088 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9089 f->async_visible = 0;
9090 f->async_iconified = 0;
9092 x_sync (f);
9094 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9097 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9099 void
9100 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9102 int result;
9103 Lisp_Object type;
9105 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9106 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9107 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9109 if (f->async_iconified)
9110 return;
9112 BLOCK_INPUT;
9114 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9116 type = x_icon_type (f);
9117 if (!NILP (type))
9118 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9120 #ifdef USE_GTK
9121 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9123 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9124 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9126 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9127 f->iconified = 1;
9128 f->visible = 1;
9129 f->async_iconified = 1;
9130 f->async_visible = 0;
9131 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9132 return;
9134 #endif
9136 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9138 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9140 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9141 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9142 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9143 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9144 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9145 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9146 so we have to record it here. */
9147 f->iconified = 1;
9148 f->visible = 1;
9149 f->async_iconified = 1;
9150 f->async_visible = 0;
9151 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9152 return;
9155 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9156 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9157 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9158 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9160 if (!result)
9161 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9163 f->async_iconified = 1;
9164 f->async_visible = 0;
9167 BLOCK_INPUT;
9168 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9169 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9170 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9172 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9173 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9174 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9175 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9176 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9177 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9179 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9180 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9182 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9183 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9185 XEvent message;
9187 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9188 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9189 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9190 message.xclient.format = 32;
9191 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9193 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9194 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9195 False,
9196 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9197 &message))
9199 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9200 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9204 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9205 IconicState. */
9206 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9208 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9210 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9211 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9214 f->async_iconified = 1;
9215 f->async_visible = 0;
9217 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9218 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9219 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9223 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9225 void
9226 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9228 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9229 Lisp_Object bar;
9230 struct scroll_bar *b;
9232 BLOCK_INPUT;
9234 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9235 commands to the X server. */
9236 if (dpyinfo->display)
9238 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9239 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9240 face. */
9241 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9242 free_frame_faces (f);
9244 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9245 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9247 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9248 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9249 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9250 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9251 toolkit scroll bars. */
9252 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9254 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9255 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9257 #endif
9259 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9260 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9261 free_frame_xic (f);
9262 #endif
9264 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9265 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9267 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9268 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9270 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9271 we are using a toolkit. */
9272 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9273 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9275 free_frame_menubar (f);
9276 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9278 #ifdef USE_GTK
9279 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9280 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9282 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9283 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9284 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9286 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9287 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9288 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9289 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9290 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9291 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9293 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9294 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9295 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9296 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9297 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9298 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9299 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9300 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9301 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9302 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9303 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9304 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9305 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9306 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9307 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9309 x_free_gcs (f);
9310 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9313 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9314 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9315 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9317 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9318 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9319 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9320 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9321 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9322 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9324 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9327 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9329 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9330 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9335 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9339 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9341 void
9342 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9344 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9346 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9347 commands to the X server. */
9348 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9349 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9351 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9355 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9357 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9358 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9359 that the window now has.
9360 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9361 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9362 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9364 #ifndef USE_GTK
9365 void
9366 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9368 XSizeHints size_hints;
9369 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9371 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9372 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9374 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9375 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9377 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9378 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9380 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9381 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9382 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9383 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9384 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9385 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9387 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9389 int base_width, base_height;
9390 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9392 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9393 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9395 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9397 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9398 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9399 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9400 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9401 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9403 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9404 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9405 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9407 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9408 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9409 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9410 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9411 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9414 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9415 if (flags)
9417 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9418 goto no_read;
9422 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9423 long supplied_return;
9424 int value;
9426 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9427 &supplied_return);
9429 if (flags)
9430 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9431 else
9433 if (value == 0)
9434 hints.flags = 0;
9435 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9436 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9437 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9438 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9439 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9440 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9441 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9442 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9446 no_read:
9448 #ifdef PWinGravity
9449 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9450 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9452 if (user_position)
9454 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9455 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9457 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9459 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9461 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9463 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9465 void
9466 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9468 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9469 Arg al[1];
9471 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9472 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9473 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9474 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9476 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9477 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9479 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9480 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9483 void
9484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9486 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9488 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9489 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9490 #endif
9492 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9494 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9495 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9496 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9497 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9499 else
9501 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9502 pixmap. */
9503 return;
9507 #ifdef USE_GTK
9509 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9510 return;
9513 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9516 Arg al[1];
9517 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9518 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9519 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9520 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9523 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9525 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9526 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9528 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9531 void
9532 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9534 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9536 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9537 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9538 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9540 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9544 /***********************************************************************
9545 Fonts
9546 ***********************************************************************/
9548 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9550 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9551 font table. */
9553 static void
9554 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9556 Lisp_Object frame;
9558 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9559 if (font->driver->check)
9560 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9563 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9566 /***********************************************************************
9567 Initialization
9568 ***********************************************************************/
9570 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9571 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9572 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9573 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9575 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9576 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9577 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9579 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9580 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9581 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9582 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9583 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9584 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9585 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9588 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9590 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9592 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9594 static int x_initialized;
9596 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9597 static int x_session_initialized;
9598 #endif
9600 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9601 the screen number from the server number. */
9602 static int
9603 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9605 int seen_colon = 0;
9606 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9607 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9608 int length_until_period = 0;
9610 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9611 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9612 length_until_period++;
9614 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9615 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9616 name1 += 4;
9617 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9618 name2 += 4;
9619 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9620 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9621 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9622 name1 += system_name_length;
9623 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9624 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9625 name2 += system_name_length;
9626 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9627 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9628 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9629 name1 += length_until_period;
9630 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9631 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9632 name2 += length_until_period;
9634 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9636 if (*name1 == ':')
9637 seen_colon++;
9638 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9639 return 1;
9641 return (seen_colon
9642 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9643 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9646 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9647 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9648 to 5. */
9649 static void
9650 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9652 int nr = 0;
9653 int off = 0;
9655 while (!(mask & 1))
9657 off++;
9658 mask >>= 1;
9661 while (mask & 1)
9663 nr++;
9664 mask >>= 1;
9667 *offset = off;
9668 *bits = nr;
9671 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9672 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9675 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9677 int dpy_ok = 1;
9678 Display *dpy;
9680 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9681 if (dpy)
9682 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9683 else
9684 dpy_ok = 0;
9685 return dpy_ok;
9688 #ifdef USE_GTK
9689 static void
9690 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level, const gchar *message, gpointer user_data)
9692 if (!strstr (message, "g_set_prgname"))
9693 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, message);
9695 #endif
9697 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9698 the structure that describes the open display.
9699 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9701 struct x_display_info *
9702 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9704 int connection;
9705 Display *dpy;
9706 struct terminal *terminal;
9707 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9708 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9710 BLOCK_INPUT;
9712 if (!x_initialized)
9714 x_initialize ();
9715 ++x_initialized;
9718 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
9719 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
9721 #ifdef USE_GTK
9723 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9724 int argc;
9725 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9726 char **argv2 = argv;
9727 guint id;
9729 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9731 xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9733 else
9735 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9736 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9738 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9739 argv[argc] = 0;
9741 argc = 0;
9742 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9744 if (! NILP (display_name))
9746 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9747 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
9750 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9751 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9753 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9755 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9756 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9757 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9758 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9759 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9760 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9762 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9763 fixup_locale ();
9764 xg_initialize ();
9766 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
9768 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9769 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9771 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9773 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9774 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9776 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9777 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9779 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9780 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
9783 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9784 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9787 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9788 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9789 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9790 errors with X11R5:
9791 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9792 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9793 So let's not use it until R6. */
9794 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9795 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9796 #endif
9799 int argc = 0;
9800 char *argv[3];
9802 argv[0] = "";
9803 argc = 1;
9804 if (xrm_option)
9806 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9807 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9809 turn_on_atimers (0);
9810 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
9811 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9812 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9813 &argc, argv);
9814 turn_on_atimers (1);
9816 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9817 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9818 fixup_locale ();
9819 #endif
9822 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9823 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9824 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
9825 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9826 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9828 /* Detect failure. */
9829 if (dpy == 0)
9831 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9832 return 0;
9835 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9837 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9838 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9840 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9843 struct x_display_info *share;
9844 Lisp_Object tail;
9846 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9847 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9848 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9849 SDATA (display_name)))
9850 break;
9851 if (share)
9852 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9853 else
9855 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9856 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9857 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
9859 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9860 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9861 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9862 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9863 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9865 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9867 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9869 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9870 list of terminals. */
9871 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9872 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9873 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9874 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
9876 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9877 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
9878 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9879 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
9880 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
9881 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
9882 BLOCK_INPUT;
9883 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
9884 terminal_list = terminal;
9885 UNGCPRO;
9888 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9889 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9890 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9891 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
9892 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
9894 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
9897 /* Put this display on the chain. */
9898 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
9899 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
9901 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
9902 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
9903 x_display_name_list);
9904 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
9906 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
9908 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
9909 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
9910 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
9911 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
9913 #if 0
9914 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
9915 #endif /* ! 0 */
9917 dpyinfo->x_id_name
9918 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
9919 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
9920 + 2);
9921 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
9922 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
9924 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
9925 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
9927 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
9928 #ifdef USE_GTK
9929 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
9930 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
9931 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9933 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
9934 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
9936 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
9937 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
9938 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
9939 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
9940 #else
9941 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
9942 #endif
9943 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
9944 all versions. */
9945 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
9947 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
9948 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
9949 select_visual (dpyinfo);
9950 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
9951 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
9952 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
9953 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
9954 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
9955 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
9956 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
9957 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
9958 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
9959 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
9960 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
9961 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9962 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9963 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9964 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9965 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
9966 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9967 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
9968 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
9969 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
9970 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
9971 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9972 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9973 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9974 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
9976 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
9977 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
9978 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
9980 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
9982 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
9983 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
9984 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
9985 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
9986 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
9987 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
9990 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
9991 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
9993 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
9995 Lisp_Object value;
9996 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
9997 build_string ("privateColormap"),
9998 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
9999 Qnil, Qnil);
10000 if (STRINGP (value)
10001 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10002 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10003 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10006 else
10007 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10008 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10010 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10012 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10013 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10014 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10015 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10016 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10017 for example). */
10018 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10019 double d;
10020 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10021 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10023 #endif
10025 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10027 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10028 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10029 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10030 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10031 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10032 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10033 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10034 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10035 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10038 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10039 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10040 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10041 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10042 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10043 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10044 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10045 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10046 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10047 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10048 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10049 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10050 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10051 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10052 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10053 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10054 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10055 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10056 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10057 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10058 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10059 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10060 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10061 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10062 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10063 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10064 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10065 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10066 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10067 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10068 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10069 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10070 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10071 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10072 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10073 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10074 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10075 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10076 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10077 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10078 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10079 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10080 /* For properties of font. */
10081 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10082 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10083 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10084 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10085 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10086 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10087 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10088 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10089 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10090 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10092 /* Ghostscript support. */
10093 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10094 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10096 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10097 False);
10099 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
10100 False);
10102 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state
10103 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE", False);
10104 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom
10105 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", False);
10106 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
10107 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ", False);
10108 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
10109 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT", False);
10110 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
10111 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", False);
10112 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type
10113 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", False);
10114 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip
10115 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP", False);
10116 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name
10117 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", False);
10118 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name
10119 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_NAME", False);
10121 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10123 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10124 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10125 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10126 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10128 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10129 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10130 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10132 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10133 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10136 dpyinfo->gray
10137 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10138 gray_bitmap_bits,
10139 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10140 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10143 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10144 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10145 #endif
10147 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10149 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10150 if (connection != 0)
10151 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10153 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10154 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10155 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10157 #ifdef SIGIO
10158 if (interrupt_input)
10159 init_sigio (connection);
10160 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10162 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10164 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10165 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10166 Font font;
10168 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10169 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10170 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10171 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10172 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10173 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10174 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10175 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10176 abort ();
10177 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10178 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10179 x_uncatch_errors ();
10181 #endif
10183 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10184 for debugging X code. */
10186 Lisp_Object value;
10187 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10188 build_string ("synchronous"),
10189 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10190 Qnil, Qnil);
10191 if (STRINGP (value)
10192 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10193 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10194 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10198 Lisp_Object value;
10199 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10200 build_string ("useXIM"),
10201 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10202 Qnil, Qnil);
10203 #ifdef USE_XIM
10204 if (STRINGP (value)
10205 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10206 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10207 use_xim = 0;
10208 #else
10209 if (STRINGP (value)
10210 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10211 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10212 use_xim = 1;
10213 #endif
10216 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10217 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10218 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10219 tty. */
10220 if (terminal->id == 1)
10221 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10222 #endif
10224 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10226 return dpyinfo;
10229 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10230 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10232 void
10233 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10235 struct terminal *t;
10237 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10238 X display. */
10239 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10240 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10242 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10243 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10244 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10245 x_session_close ();
10246 #endif
10247 delete_terminal (t);
10248 break;
10251 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10253 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10254 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10255 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10256 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10257 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10258 else
10260 Lisp_Object tail;
10262 tail = x_display_name_list;
10263 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10265 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10267 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10268 break;
10270 tail = XCDR (tail);
10274 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10275 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10277 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10278 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10279 else
10281 struct x_display_info *tail;
10283 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10284 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10285 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10288 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10289 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10290 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10291 xfree (dpyinfo);
10294 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10296 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10297 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10298 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10299 that slows us down. */
10301 static void
10302 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10304 BLOCK_INPUT;
10305 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10306 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10308 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10309 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10310 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10311 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10313 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10316 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10317 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10318 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10319 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10320 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10321 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10322 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10324 void
10325 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10327 BLOCK_INPUT;
10328 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10330 EMACS_TIME interval;
10332 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10333 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10334 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10336 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10339 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10342 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10344 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10346 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10348 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10349 x_produce_glyphs,
10350 x_write_glyphs,
10351 x_insert_glyphs,
10352 x_clear_end_of_line,
10353 x_scroll_run,
10354 x_after_update_window_line,
10355 x_update_window_begin,
10356 x_update_window_end,
10357 x_cursor_to,
10358 x_flush,
10359 #ifdef XFlush
10360 x_flush,
10361 #else
10362 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10363 #endif
10364 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10365 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10366 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10367 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10368 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10369 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10370 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10371 x_draw_glyph_string,
10372 x_define_frame_cursor,
10373 x_clear_frame_area,
10374 x_draw_window_cursor,
10375 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10376 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10380 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10381 void
10382 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10386 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10387 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10388 if (!terminal->name)
10389 return;
10391 BLOCK_INPUT;
10392 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10393 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10394 X display. */
10395 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10396 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10397 #endif
10399 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10400 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10401 if (dpyinfo->display)
10403 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10404 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10406 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10407 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10408 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10409 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10411 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10412 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10413 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10414 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10415 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10416 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10417 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10418 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10419 leaks in other situations. */
10420 #if 0
10421 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10422 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10423 #else
10424 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10425 #endif
10426 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10427 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10428 closing all the displays. */
10429 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10430 #endif
10432 #ifdef USE_GTK
10433 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10434 #else
10435 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10436 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10437 #else
10438 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10439 #endif
10440 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10443 /* Mark as dead. */
10444 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10445 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10446 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10449 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10450 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10452 static struct terminal *
10453 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10455 struct terminal *terminal;
10457 terminal = create_terminal ();
10459 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10460 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10461 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10463 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10465 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10466 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10467 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10468 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10469 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10470 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10471 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10472 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10473 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10474 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10475 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10476 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10477 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10478 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10479 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10480 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10481 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10482 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10483 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10484 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10486 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10487 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10489 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10490 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10491 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10492 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10493 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10494 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10495 off the bottom. */
10497 return terminal;
10500 void
10501 x_initialize (void)
10503 baud_rate = 19200;
10505 x_noop_count = 0;
10506 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10507 any_help_event_p = 0;
10508 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10509 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10510 x_session_initialized = 0;
10511 #endif
10513 #ifdef USE_GTK
10514 current_count = -1;
10515 #endif
10517 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10518 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10520 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10521 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10523 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10525 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10526 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10527 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10528 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10529 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10530 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10531 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10533 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10534 #endif
10536 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10537 #ifndef USE_GTK
10538 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10539 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10540 #endif
10541 #endif
10543 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10544 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10545 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10547 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10548 original error handler. */
10549 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10550 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10552 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10554 xgselect_initialize ();
10558 void
10559 syms_of_xterm (void)
10561 x_error_message = NULL;
10563 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10564 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10566 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10567 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10569 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10570 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10572 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10573 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10575 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10576 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10578 #ifdef USE_GTK
10579 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10580 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10582 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10583 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10584 #endif
10586 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10587 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10588 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10589 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10590 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10591 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10592 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10593 sizes. */);
10594 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10596 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10597 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10598 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10599 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10600 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10601 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10602 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10604 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10605 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10606 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10607 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10608 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10609 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10610 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10611 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10612 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10614 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10615 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10616 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10617 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10618 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10619 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10620 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10621 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10622 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10623 #elif USE_GTK
10624 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10625 #else
10626 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10627 #endif
10628 #else
10629 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10630 #endif
10632 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10633 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10635 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10636 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10637 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10638 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10639 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10640 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10641 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10642 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10643 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10645 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10646 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10647 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10648 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10649 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10650 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10652 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10653 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10654 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10655 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10656 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10657 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10659 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10660 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10661 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10662 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10663 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10664 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10666 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10667 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10668 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10669 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10670 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10671 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10673 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10674 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10675 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10676 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10677 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10678 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10681 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10683 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10684 (do not change this comment) */